|  | /* Linker command language support. | 
|  | Copyright (C) 1991-2025 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | 
|  |  | 
|  | This file is part of the GNU Binutils. | 
|  |  | 
|  | This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify | 
|  | it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by | 
|  | the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or | 
|  | (at your option) any later version. | 
|  |  | 
|  | This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | 
|  | but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | 
|  | MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the | 
|  | GNU General Public License for more details. | 
|  |  | 
|  | You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | 
|  | along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software | 
|  | Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, | 
|  | MA 02110-1301, USA.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | #include "sysdep.h" | 
|  | #include <limits.h> | 
|  | #include "bfd.h" | 
|  | #include "libiberty.h" | 
|  | #include "filenames.h" | 
|  | #include "safe-ctype.h" | 
|  | #include "obstack.h" | 
|  | #include "bfdlink.h" | 
|  | #include "ctf-api.h" | 
|  | #include "ld.h" | 
|  | #include "ldmain.h" | 
|  | #include "ldexp.h" | 
|  | #include "ldlang.h" | 
|  | #include <ldgram.h> | 
|  | #include "ldlex.h" | 
|  | #include "ldmisc.h" | 
|  | #include "ldctor.h" | 
|  | #include "ldfile.h" | 
|  | #include "ldemul.h" | 
|  | #include "ldwrite.h" | 
|  | #include "fnmatch.h" | 
|  | #include "demangle.h" | 
|  | #include "hashtab.h" | 
|  | #include "elf-bfd.h" | 
|  | #include "bfdver.h" | 
|  |  | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | #include "plugin.h" | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* FIXME: Put it here to avoid NAME conflict from ldgram.h.  */ | 
|  | #include "elf-bfd.h" | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifndef offsetof | 
|  | #define offsetof(TYPE, MEMBER) ((size_t) & (((TYPE*) 0)->MEMBER)) | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Convert between addresses in bytes and sizes in octets. | 
|  | For currently supported targets, octets_per_byte is always a power | 
|  | of two, so we can use shifts.  */ | 
|  | #define TO_ADDR(X) ((X) >> opb_shift) | 
|  | #define TO_SIZE(X) ((X) << opb_shift) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Local variables.  */ | 
|  | static struct obstack stat_obstack; | 
|  | static struct obstack map_obstack; | 
|  | static struct obstack pt_obstack; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define obstack_chunk_alloc xmalloc | 
|  | #define obstack_chunk_free free | 
|  | static const char *entry_symbol_default = "start"; | 
|  | static bool map_head_is_link_order = false; | 
|  | static lang_output_section_statement_type *default_common_section; | 
|  | static bool map_option_f; | 
|  | static bfd_vma print_dot; | 
|  | static lang_input_statement_type *first_file; | 
|  | static const char *current_target; | 
|  | static lang_statement_list_type *stat_save[10]; | 
|  | static lang_statement_list_type **stat_save_ptr = &stat_save[0]; | 
|  | static struct unique_sections *unique_section_list; | 
|  | static struct asneeded_minfo *asneeded_list_head; | 
|  | static unsigned int opb_shift = 0; | 
|  | static cmdline_list_type cmdline_object_only_file_list; | 
|  | static cmdline_list_type cmdline_object_only_archive_list; | 
|  | static cmdline_list_type cmdline_temp_object_only_list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Forward declarations.  */ | 
|  | static void exp_init_os (etree_type *); | 
|  | static lang_input_statement_type *lookup_name (const char *); | 
|  | static bool wont_add_section_p (asection *, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *); | 
|  | static void insert_undefined (const char *); | 
|  | static bool sort_def_symbol (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *, void *); | 
|  | static lang_statement_union_type *new_statement (enum statement_enum type, | 
|  | size_t size, | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type *list); | 
|  | static void print_statement (lang_statement_union_type *, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *); | 
|  | static void print_statement_list (lang_statement_union_type *, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *); | 
|  | static void print_statements (void); | 
|  | static void print_input_section (asection *, bool); | 
|  | static bool lang_one_common (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *, void *); | 
|  | static void lang_record_phdrs (void); | 
|  | static void lang_do_version_exports_section (void); | 
|  | static void lang_finalize_version_expr_head | 
|  | (struct bfd_elf_version_expr_head *); | 
|  | static void lang_do_memory_regions (bool); | 
|  | static void cmdline_lists_init (void); | 
|  | static void cmdline_get_object_only_input_files (void); | 
|  | static void print_cmdline_list (cmdline_union_type *); | 
|  | static bool cmdline_on_object_only_archive_list_p (bfd *); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Exported variables.  */ | 
|  | const char *output_target; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *abs_output_section; | 
|  | /* Header for list of statements corresponding to any files involved in the | 
|  | link, either specified from the command-line or added implicitely (eg. | 
|  | archive member used to resolved undefined symbol, wildcard statement from | 
|  | linker script, etc.).  Next pointer is in next field of a | 
|  | lang_statement_header_type (reached via header field in a | 
|  | lang_statement_union).  */ | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type statement_list; | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type lang_os_list; | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type *stat_ptr = &statement_list; | 
|  | /* Header for list of statements corresponding to files used in the final | 
|  | executable.  This can be either object file specified on the command-line | 
|  | or library member resolving an undefined reference.  Next pointer is in next | 
|  | field of a lang_input_statement_type (reached via input_statement field in a | 
|  | lang_statement_union).  */ | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type file_chain = { NULL, NULL }; | 
|  | /* Header for list of statements corresponding to files specified on the | 
|  | command-line for linking.  It thus contains real object files and archive | 
|  | but not archive members.  Next pointer is in next_real_file field of a | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type statement (reached via input_statement field in a | 
|  | lang_statement_union).  */ | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type input_file_chain; | 
|  | static const char *current_input_file; | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_dynamic_list **current_dynamic_list_p; | 
|  | struct bfd_sym_chain entry_symbol = { NULL, NULL }; | 
|  | const char *entry_section = ".text"; | 
|  | struct lang_input_statement_flags input_flags; | 
|  | bool entry_from_cmdline; | 
|  | bool lang_has_input_file = false; | 
|  | bool had_output_filename = false; | 
|  | bool lang_float_flag = false; | 
|  | bool delete_output_file_on_failure = false; | 
|  | bool enable_linker_version = false; | 
|  | struct lang_phdr *lang_phdr_list; | 
|  | struct lang_nocrossrefs *nocrossref_list; | 
|  | struct asneeded_minfo **asneeded_list_tail; | 
|  | #ifdef ENABLE_LIBCTF | 
|  | static ctf_dict_t *ctf_output; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Functions that traverse the linker script and might evaluate | 
|  | DEFINED() need to increment this at the start of the traversal.  */ | 
|  | int lang_statement_iteration = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Count times through one_lang_size_sections_pass after mark phase.  */ | 
|  | static int lang_sizing_iteration = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return TRUE if the PATTERN argument is a wildcard pattern. | 
|  | Although backslashes are treated specially if a pattern contains | 
|  | wildcards, we do not consider the mere presence of a backslash to | 
|  | be enough to cause the pattern to be treated as a wildcard. | 
|  | That lets us handle DOS filenames more naturally.  */ | 
|  | #define wildcardp(pattern) (strpbrk ((pattern), "?*[") != NULL) | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define new_stat(x, y) \ | 
|  | (x##_type *) new_statement (x##_enum, sizeof (x##_type), y) | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define outside_section_address(q) \ | 
|  | ((q)->output_offset + (q)->output_section->vma) | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define outside_symbol_address(q) \ | 
|  | ((q)->value + outside_section_address (q->section)) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* CTF sections smaller than this are not compressed: compression of | 
|  | dictionaries this small doesn't gain much, and this lets consumers mmap the | 
|  | sections directly out of the ELF file and use them with no decompression | 
|  | overhead if they want to.  */ | 
|  | #define CTF_COMPRESSION_THRESHOLD 4096 | 
|  |  | 
|  | void * | 
|  | stat_alloc (size_t size) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return obstack_alloc (&stat_obstack, size); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | stat_free (void *str) | 
|  | { | 
|  | obstack_free (&stat_obstack, str); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void * | 
|  | stat_memdup (const void *src, size_t copy_size, size_t alloc_size) | 
|  | { | 
|  | void *ret = obstack_alloc (&stat_obstack, alloc_size); | 
|  | memcpy (ret, src, copy_size); | 
|  | if (alloc_size > copy_size) | 
|  | memset ((char *) ret + copy_size, 0, alloc_size - copy_size); | 
|  | return ret; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | char * | 
|  | stat_strdup (const char *str) | 
|  | { | 
|  | size_t len = strlen (str) + 1; | 
|  | return stat_memdup (str, len, len); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | char * | 
|  | stat_concat (const char *first, ...) | 
|  | { | 
|  | va_list args; | 
|  | va_start (args, first); | 
|  |  | 
|  | size_t length = 0; | 
|  | for (const char *arg = first; arg; arg = va_arg (args, const char *)) | 
|  | length += strlen (arg); | 
|  | va_end (args); | 
|  | char *new_str = stat_alloc (length + 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | va_start (args, first); | 
|  | char *end = new_str; | 
|  | for (const char *arg = first; arg; arg = va_arg (args, const char *)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | length = strlen (arg); | 
|  | memcpy (end, arg, length); | 
|  | end += length; | 
|  | } | 
|  | *end = 0; | 
|  | va_end (args); | 
|  | return new_str; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Code for handling simple wildcards without going through fnmatch, | 
|  | which can be expensive because of charset translations etc.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A simple wild is a literal string followed by a single '*', | 
|  | where the literal part is at least 4 characters long.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | is_simple_wild (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | size_t len = strcspn (name, "*?["); | 
|  | return len >= 4 && name[len] == '*' && name[len + 1] == '\0'; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | match_simple_wild (const char *pattern, const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The first four characters of the pattern are guaranteed valid | 
|  | non-wildcard characters.  So we can go faster.  */ | 
|  | if (pattern[0] != name[0] || pattern[1] != name[1] | 
|  | || pattern[2] != name[2] || pattern[3] != name[3]) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | pattern += 4; | 
|  | name += 4; | 
|  | while (*pattern != '*') | 
|  | if (*name++ != *pattern++) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | name_match (const char *pattern, const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (is_simple_wild (pattern)) | 
|  | return !match_simple_wild (pattern, name); | 
|  | if (wildcardp (pattern)) | 
|  | return fnmatch (pattern, name, 0); | 
|  | return strcmp (pattern, name); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Given an analyzed wildcard_spec SPEC, match it against NAME, | 
|  | returns zero on a match, non-zero if there's no match.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | spec_match (const struct wildcard_spec *spec, const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | size_t nl = spec->namelen; | 
|  | size_t pl = spec->prefixlen; | 
|  | size_t sl = spec->suffixlen; | 
|  | size_t inputlen = strlen (name); | 
|  | int r; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (pl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (inputlen < pl) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | r = memcmp (spec->name, name, pl); | 
|  | if (r) | 
|  | return r; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sl) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (inputlen < sl) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | r = memcmp (spec->name + nl - sl, name + inputlen - sl, sl); | 
|  | if (r) | 
|  | return r; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (nl == pl + sl + 1 && spec->name[pl] == '*') | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (nl > pl) | 
|  | return fnmatch (spec->name + pl, name + pl, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (inputlen >= nl) | 
|  | return name[nl]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static char * | 
|  | ldirname (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *base = lbasename (name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (base > name && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (base[-1])) | 
|  | --base; | 
|  | size_t len = base - name; | 
|  | if (len == 0) | 
|  | return "."; | 
|  | return stat_memdup (name, len, len + 1); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If PATTERN is of the form archive:file, return a pointer to the | 
|  | separator.  If not, return NULL.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static char * | 
|  | archive_path (const char *pattern) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *p = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.path_separator == 0) | 
|  | return p; | 
|  |  | 
|  | p = strchr (pattern, link_info.path_separator); | 
|  | #ifdef HAVE_DOS_BASED_FILE_SYSTEM | 
|  | if (p == NULL || link_info.path_separator != ':') | 
|  | return p; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Assume a match on the second char is part of drive specifier, | 
|  | as in "c:\silly.dos".  */ | 
|  | if (p == pattern + 1 && ISALPHA (*pattern)) | 
|  | p = strchr (p + 1, link_info.path_separator); | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | return p; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Given that FILE_SPEC results in a non-NULL SEP result from archive_path, | 
|  | return whether F matches FILE_SPEC.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | input_statement_is_archive_path (const char *file_spec, char *sep, | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *f) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool match = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((*(sep + 1) == 0 | 
|  | || name_match (sep + 1, f->filename) == 0) | 
|  | && ((sep != file_spec) | 
|  | == (f->the_bfd != NULL && f->the_bfd->my_archive != NULL))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | match = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sep != file_spec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *aname = bfd_get_filename (f->the_bfd->my_archive); | 
|  | *sep = 0; | 
|  | match = name_match (file_spec, aname) == 0; | 
|  | *sep = link_info.path_separator; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return match; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | unique_section_p (const asection *sec, | 
|  | const lang_output_section_statement_type *os) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct unique_sections *unam; | 
|  | const char *secnam; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!link_info.resolve_section_groups | 
|  | && sec->owner != NULL | 
|  | && bfd_is_group_section (sec->owner, sec)) | 
|  | return !(os != NULL | 
|  | && strcmp (os->name, DISCARD_SECTION_NAME) == 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | secnam = sec->name; | 
|  | for (unam = unique_section_list; unam; unam = unam->next) | 
|  | if (name_match (unam->name, secnam) == 0) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Generic traversal routines for finding matching sections.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return true if FILE matches a pattern in EXCLUDE_LIST, otherwise return | 
|  | false.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | walk_wild_file_in_exclude_list (struct name_list *exclude_list, | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct name_list *list_tmp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (list_tmp = exclude_list; | 
|  | list_tmp; | 
|  | list_tmp = list_tmp->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *p = archive_path (list_tmp->name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (p != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (input_statement_is_archive_path (list_tmp->name, p, file)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | else if (name_match (list_tmp->name, file->filename) == 0) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* FIXME: Perhaps remove the following at some stage?  Matching | 
|  | unadorned archives like this was never documented and has | 
|  | been superceded by the archive:path syntax.  */ | 
|  | else if (file->the_bfd != NULL | 
|  | && file->the_bfd->my_archive != NULL | 
|  | && name_match (list_tmp->name, | 
|  | bfd_get_filename (file->the_bfd->my_archive)) == 0) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add SECTION (from input FILE) to the list of matching sections | 
|  | within PTR (the matching wildcard is SEC).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | add_matching_section (lang_wild_statement_type *ptr, | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec, | 
|  | asection *section, | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_matcher_type *new_section; | 
|  | /* Add a section reference to the list.  */ | 
|  | new_section = new_stat (lang_input_matcher, &ptr->matching_sections); | 
|  | new_section->section = section; | 
|  | new_section->pattern = sec; | 
|  | new_section->input_stmt = file; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Process section S (from input file FILE) in relation to wildcard | 
|  | statement PTR.  We already know that a prefix of the name of S matches | 
|  | some wildcard in PTR's wildcard list.  Here we check if the filename | 
|  | matches as well (if it's specified) and if any of the wildcards in fact | 
|  | does match.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | walk_wild_section_match (lang_wild_statement_type *ptr, | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *file, | 
|  | asection *s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec; | 
|  | const char *file_spec = ptr->filename; | 
|  | char *p; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check if filenames match.  */ | 
|  | if (file_spec == NULL) | 
|  | ; | 
|  | else if ((p = archive_path (file_spec)) != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!input_statement_is_archive_path (file_spec, p, file)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (wildcardp (file_spec)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (fnmatch (file_spec, file->filename, 0) != 0) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* XXX Matching against non-wildcard filename in wild statements | 
|  | was done by going through lookup_name, which uses | 
|  | ->local_sym_name to compare against, not ->filename.  We retain | 
|  | this behaviour even though the above code paths use filename. | 
|  | It would be more logical to use it here as well, in which | 
|  | case the above wildcard() arm could be folded into this by using | 
|  | name_match.  This would also solve the worry of what to do | 
|  | about unset local_sym_name (in which case lookup_name simply adds | 
|  | the input file again).  */ | 
|  | const char *filename = file->local_sym_name; | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *arch_is; | 
|  | if (filename && filename_cmp (filename, file_spec) == 0) | 
|  | ; | 
|  | /* FIXME: see also walk_wild_file_in_exclude_list for why we | 
|  | also check parents BFD (local_sym_)name to match input statements | 
|  | with unadorned archive names.  */ | 
|  | else if (file->the_bfd | 
|  | && file->the_bfd->my_archive | 
|  | && (arch_is = bfd_usrdata (file->the_bfd->my_archive)) | 
|  | && arch_is->local_sym_name | 
|  | && filename_cmp (arch_is->local_sym_name, file_spec) == 0) | 
|  | ; | 
|  | else | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If filename is excluded we're done.  */ | 
|  | if (walk_wild_file_in_exclude_list (ptr->exclude_name_list, file)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check section name against each wildcard spec.  If there's no | 
|  | wildcard all sections match.  */ | 
|  | sec = ptr->section_list; | 
|  | if (sec == NULL) | 
|  | add_matching_section (ptr, sec, s, file); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *sname = bfd_section_name (s); | 
|  | for (; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (sec->spec.name != NULL | 
|  | && spec_match (&sec->spec, sname) != 0) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Don't process sections from files which were excluded.  */ | 
|  | if (!walk_wild_file_in_exclude_list (sec->spec.exclude_name_list, | 
|  | file)) | 
|  | add_matching_section (ptr, sec, s, file); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return the numerical value of the init_priority attribute from | 
|  | section name NAME.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | get_init_priority (const asection *sec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *name = bfd_section_name (sec); | 
|  | const char *dot; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* GCC uses the following section names for the init_priority | 
|  | attribute with numerical values 101 to 65535 inclusive. A | 
|  | lower value means a higher priority. | 
|  |  | 
|  | 1: .init_array.NNNNN/.fini_array.NNNNN: Where NNNNN is the | 
|  | decimal numerical value of the init_priority attribute. | 
|  | The order of execution in .init_array is forward and | 
|  | .fini_array is backward. | 
|  | 2: .ctors.NNNNN/.dtors.NNNNN: Where NNNNN is 65535 minus the | 
|  | decimal numerical value of the init_priority attribute. | 
|  | The order of execution in .ctors is backward and .dtors | 
|  | is forward. | 
|  |  | 
|  | .init_array.NNNNN sections would normally be placed in an output | 
|  | .init_array section, .fini_array.NNNNN in .fini_array, | 
|  | .ctors.NNNNN in .ctors, and .dtors.NNNNN in .dtors.  This means | 
|  | we should sort by increasing number (and could just use | 
|  | SORT_BY_NAME in scripts).  However if .ctors.NNNNN sections are | 
|  | being placed in .init_array (which may also contain | 
|  | .init_array.NNNNN sections) or .dtors.NNNNN sections are being | 
|  | placed in .fini_array then we need to extract the init_priority | 
|  | attribute and sort on that.  */ | 
|  | dot = strrchr (name, '.'); | 
|  | if (dot != NULL && ISDIGIT (dot[1])) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *end; | 
|  | unsigned long init_priority = strtoul (dot + 1, &end, 10); | 
|  | if (*end == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (dot == name + 6 | 
|  | && (strncmp (name, ".ctors", 6) == 0 | 
|  | || strncmp (name, ".dtors", 6) == 0)) | 
|  | init_priority = 65535 - init_priority; | 
|  | if (init_priority <= INT_MAX) | 
|  | return init_priority; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return -1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Compare sections ASEC and BSEC according to SORT.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | compare_section (sort_type sort, asection *asec, asection *bsec, bool reversed) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int ret; | 
|  | int a_priority, b_priority; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (sort) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_init_priority: | 
|  | a_priority = get_init_priority (asec); | 
|  | b_priority = get_init_priority (bsec); | 
|  | if (a_priority < 0 || b_priority < 0) | 
|  | goto sort_by_name; | 
|  | if (reversed) | 
|  | ret = b_priority - a_priority; | 
|  | else | 
|  | ret = a_priority - b_priority; | 
|  | if (ret) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | else | 
|  | goto sort_by_name; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_alignment_name: | 
|  | ret = bfd_section_alignment (bsec) - bfd_section_alignment (asec); | 
|  | if (ret) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | /* Fall through.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_name: | 
|  | sort_by_name: | 
|  | if (reversed) | 
|  | ret = strcmp (bfd_section_name (bsec), bfd_section_name (asec)); | 
|  | else | 
|  | ret = strcmp (bfd_section_name (asec), bfd_section_name (bsec)); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_name_alignment: | 
|  | if (reversed) | 
|  | ret = strcmp (bfd_section_name (bsec), bfd_section_name (asec)); | 
|  | else | 
|  | ret = strcmp (bfd_section_name (asec), bfd_section_name (bsec)); | 
|  | if (ret) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | /* Fall through.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_alignment: | 
|  | ret = bfd_section_alignment (bsec) - bfd_section_alignment (asec); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return ret; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* PE puts the sort key in the input statement.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char * | 
|  | sort_filename (bfd *abfd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *is = bfd_usrdata (abfd); | 
|  | if (is->sort_key) | 
|  | return is->sort_key; | 
|  | return bfd_get_filename (abfd); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Handle wildcard sorting.  This returns the place in a binary search tree | 
|  | where this FILE:SECTION should be inserted for wild statement WILD where | 
|  | the spec SEC was the matching one.  The tree is later linearized.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_section_bst_type ** | 
|  | wild_sort (lang_wild_statement_type *wild, | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec, | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *file, | 
|  | asection *section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_section_bst_type **tree; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!wild->filenames_sorted | 
|  | && (sec == NULL || sec->spec.sorted == none | 
|  | || sec->spec.sorted == by_none)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We might be called even if _this_ spec doesn't need sorting, | 
|  | in which case we simply append at the right end of tree.  */ | 
|  | return wild->rightmost; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | tree = &wild->tree; | 
|  | while (*tree) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Sorting by filename takes precedence over sorting by section | 
|  | name.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (wild->filenames_sorted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *fn, *ln; | 
|  | bool fa, la; | 
|  | int i; | 
|  | asection *lsec = (*tree)->section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The PE support for the .idata section as generated by | 
|  | dlltool assumes that files will be sorted by the name of | 
|  | the archive and then the name of the file within the | 
|  | archive.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | fa = file->the_bfd->my_archive != NULL; | 
|  | if (fa) | 
|  | fn = sort_filename (file->the_bfd->my_archive); | 
|  | else | 
|  | fn = sort_filename (file->the_bfd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | la = lsec->owner->my_archive != NULL; | 
|  | if (la) | 
|  | ln = sort_filename (lsec->owner->my_archive); | 
|  | else | 
|  | ln = sort_filename (lsec->owner); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (wild->filenames_reversed) | 
|  | i = filename_cmp (ln, fn); | 
|  | else | 
|  | i = filename_cmp (fn, ln); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (i > 0) | 
|  | { tree = &((*tree)->right); continue; } | 
|  | else if (i < 0) | 
|  | { tree = &((*tree)->left); continue; } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (fa || la) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (fa) | 
|  | fn = sort_filename (file->the_bfd); | 
|  | if (la) | 
|  | ln = sort_filename (lsec->owner); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (wild->filenames_reversed) | 
|  | i = filename_cmp (ln, fn); | 
|  | else | 
|  | i = filename_cmp (fn, ln); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (i > 0) | 
|  | { tree = &((*tree)->right); continue; } | 
|  | else if (i < 0) | 
|  | { tree = &((*tree)->left); continue; } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Here either the files are not sorted by name, or we are | 
|  | looking at the sections for this file.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find the correct node to append this section.  */ | 
|  | if (sec && sec->spec.sorted != none && sec->spec.sorted != by_none | 
|  | && compare_section (sec->spec.sorted, section, (*tree)->section, sec->spec.reversed) < 0) | 
|  | tree = &((*tree)->left); | 
|  | else | 
|  | tree = &((*tree)->right); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return tree; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Use wild_sort to build a BST to sort sections.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | output_section_callback_sort (lang_wild_statement_type *ptr, | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec, | 
|  | asection *section, | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *file, | 
|  | void *output) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_section_bst_type *node; | 
|  | lang_section_bst_type **tree; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os = (lang_output_section_statement_type *) output; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (unique_section_p (section, os)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Don't add sections to the tree when we already know that | 
|  | lang_add_section won't do anything with it.  */ | 
|  | if (wont_add_section_p (section, os)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | node = stat_alloc (sizeof (*node)); | 
|  | node->left = 0; | 
|  | node->right = 0; | 
|  | node->section = section; | 
|  | node->pattern = ptr->section_list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | tree = wild_sort (ptr, sec, file, section); | 
|  | if (tree != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *tree = node; | 
|  | if (tree == ptr->rightmost) | 
|  | ptr->rightmost = &node->right; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Convert a sorted sections' BST back to list form.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | output_section_callback_tree_to_list (lang_wild_statement_type *ptr, | 
|  | lang_section_bst_type *tree, | 
|  | void *output) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (tree->left) | 
|  | output_section_callback_tree_to_list (ptr, tree->left, output); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_add_section (&ptr->children, tree->section, tree->pattern, | 
|  | ptr->section_flag_list, | 
|  | (lang_output_section_statement_type *) output); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (tree->right) | 
|  | output_section_callback_tree_to_list (ptr, tree->right, output); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Sections are matched against wildcard statements via a prefix tree. | 
|  | The prefix tree holds prefixes of all matching patterns (up to the first | 
|  | wildcard character), and the wild statement from which those patterns | 
|  | came.  When matching a section name against the tree we're walking through | 
|  | the tree character by character.  Each statement we hit is one that | 
|  | potentially matches.  This is checked by actually going through the | 
|  | (glob) matching routines. | 
|  |  | 
|  | When the section name turns out to actually match we record that section | 
|  | in the wild statements list of matching sections.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A prefix can be matched by multiple statement, so we need a list of them.  */ | 
|  | struct wild_stmt_list | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_wild_statement_type *stmt; | 
|  | struct wild_stmt_list *next; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The prefix tree itself.  */ | 
|  | struct prefixtree | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The list of all children (linked via .next).  */ | 
|  | struct prefixtree *child; | 
|  | struct prefixtree *next; | 
|  | /* This tree node is responsible for the prefix of parent plus 'c'.  */ | 
|  | char c; | 
|  | /* The statements that potentially can match this prefix.  */ | 
|  | struct wild_stmt_list *stmt; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We always have a root node in the prefix tree.  It corresponds to the | 
|  | empty prefix.  E.g. a glob like "*" would sit in this root.  */ | 
|  | static struct prefixtree the_root, *ptroot = &the_root; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Given a prefix tree in *TREE, corresponding to prefix P, find or | 
|  | INSERT the tree node corresponding to prefix P+C.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct prefixtree * | 
|  | get_prefix_tree (struct prefixtree **tree, char c, bool insert) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct prefixtree *t; | 
|  | for (t = *tree; t; t = t->next) | 
|  | if (t->c == c) | 
|  | return t; | 
|  | if (!insert) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | t = (struct prefixtree *) obstack_alloc (&pt_obstack, sizeof *t); | 
|  | t->child = NULL; | 
|  | t->next = *tree; | 
|  | t->c = c; | 
|  | t->stmt = NULL; | 
|  | *tree = t; | 
|  | return t; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add STMT to the set of statements that can be matched by the prefix | 
|  | corresponding to prefix tree T.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | pt_add_stmt (struct prefixtree *t, lang_wild_statement_type *stmt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wild_stmt_list *sl, **psl; | 
|  | sl = (struct wild_stmt_list *) obstack_alloc (&pt_obstack, sizeof *sl); | 
|  | sl->stmt = stmt; | 
|  | sl->next = NULL; | 
|  | psl = &t->stmt; | 
|  | while (*psl) | 
|  | psl = &(*psl)->next; | 
|  | *psl = sl; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Insert STMT into the global prefix tree.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | insert_prefix_tree (lang_wild_statement_type *stmt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec; | 
|  | struct prefixtree *t; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!stmt->section_list) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If we have no section_list (no wildcards in the wild STMT), | 
|  | then every section name will match, so add this to the root.  */ | 
|  | pt_add_stmt (ptroot, stmt); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (sec = stmt->section_list; sec; sec = sec->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *name = sec->spec.name ? sec->spec.name : "*"; | 
|  | char c; | 
|  | t = ptroot; | 
|  | for (; (c = *name); name++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (c == '*' || c == '[' || c == '?') | 
|  | break; | 
|  | t = get_prefix_tree (&t->child, c, true); | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* If we hit a glob character, the matching prefix is what we saw | 
|  | until now.  If we hit the end of pattern (hence it's no glob) then | 
|  | we can do better: we only need to record a match when a section name | 
|  | completely matches, not merely a prefix, so record the trailing 0 | 
|  | as well.  */ | 
|  | if (!c) | 
|  | t = get_prefix_tree (&t->child, 0, true); | 
|  | pt_add_stmt (t, stmt); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Dump T indented by INDENT spaces.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | debug_prefix_tree_rec (struct prefixtree *t, int indent) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; t; t = t->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wild_stmt_list *sl; | 
|  | printf ("%*s %c", indent, "", t->c); | 
|  | for (sl = t->stmt; sl; sl = sl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *curr; | 
|  | printf (" %p ", sl->stmt); | 
|  | for (curr = sl->stmt->section_list; curr; curr = curr->next) | 
|  | printf ("%s ", curr->spec.name ? curr->spec.name : "*"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | printf ("\n"); | 
|  | debug_prefix_tree_rec (t->child, indent + 2); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Dump the global prefix tree.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | debug_prefix_tree (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | debug_prefix_tree_rec (ptroot, 2); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Like strcspn() but start to look from the end to beginning of | 
|  | S.  Returns the length of the suffix of S consisting entirely | 
|  | of characters not in REJECT.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static size_t | 
|  | rstrcspn (const char *s, const char *reject) | 
|  | { | 
|  | size_t len = strlen (s), sufflen = 0; | 
|  | while (len--) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char c = s[len]; | 
|  | if (strchr (reject, c) != 0) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | sufflen++; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return sufflen; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Analyze the wildcards in wild statement PTR to setup various | 
|  | things for quick matching.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | analyze_walk_wild_section_handler (lang_wild_statement_type *ptr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ptr->tree = NULL; | 
|  | ptr->rightmost = &ptr->tree; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (sec = ptr->section_list; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (sec->spec.name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | sec->spec.namelen = strlen (sec->spec.name); | 
|  | sec->spec.prefixlen = strcspn (sec->spec.name, "?*["); | 
|  | sec->spec.suffixlen = rstrcspn (sec->spec.name + sec->spec.prefixlen, | 
|  | "?*]"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | sec->spec.namelen = sec->spec.prefixlen = sec->spec.suffixlen = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | insert_prefix_tree (ptr); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Match all sections from FILE against the global prefix tree, | 
|  | and record them into each wild statement that has a match.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | resolve_wild_sections (lang_input_statement_type *file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (file->flags.just_syms) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (s = file->the_bfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *sname = bfd_section_name (s); | 
|  | char c = 1; | 
|  | struct prefixtree *t = ptroot; | 
|  | //printf (" YYY consider %s of %s\n", sname, file->the_bfd->filename); | 
|  | do | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (t->stmt) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wild_stmt_list *sl; | 
|  | for (sl = t->stmt; sl; sl = sl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | walk_wild_section_match (sl->stmt, file, s); | 
|  | //printf ("   ZZZ maybe place into %p\n", sl->stmt); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (!c) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | c = *sname++; | 
|  | t = get_prefix_tree (&t->child, c, false); | 
|  | } | 
|  | while (t); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Match all sections from all input files against the global prefix tree.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | resolve_wilds (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (f) | 
|  | { | 
|  | //printf("XXX   %s\n", f->filename); | 
|  | if (f->the_bfd == NULL | 
|  | || !bfd_check_format (f->the_bfd, bfd_archive)) | 
|  | resolve_wild_sections (f); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd *member; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is an archive file.  We must map each member of the | 
|  | archive separately.  */ | 
|  | member = bfd_openr_next_archived_file (f->the_bfd, NULL); | 
|  | while (member != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* When lookup_name is called, it will call the add_symbols | 
|  | entry point for the archive.  For each element of the | 
|  | archive which is included, BFD will call ldlang_add_file, | 
|  | which will set the usrdata field of the member to the | 
|  | lang_input_statement.  */ | 
|  | if (bfd_usrdata (member) != NULL) | 
|  | resolve_wild_sections (bfd_usrdata (member)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | member = bfd_openr_next_archived_file (f->the_bfd, member); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For each input section that matches wild statement S calls | 
|  | CALLBACK with DATA.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | walk_wild (lang_wild_statement_type *s, callback_t callback, void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type *l; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (l = s->matching_sections.head; l; l = l->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | (*callback) (s, l->input_matcher.pattern, l->input_matcher.section, | 
|  | l->input_matcher.input_stmt, data); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* lang_for_each_statement walks the parse tree and calls the provided | 
|  | function for each node, except those inside output section statements | 
|  | with constraint set to -1.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_for_each_statement_worker (void (*func) (lang_statement_union_type *), | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type *s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; s != NULL; s = s->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | func (s); | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (s->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | lang_for_each_statement_worker (func, constructor_list.head); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | if (s->output_section_statement.constraint != -1) | 
|  | lang_for_each_statement_worker | 
|  | (func, s->output_section_statement.children.head); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | lang_for_each_statement_worker (func, | 
|  | s->wild_statement.children.head); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | lang_for_each_statement_worker (func, | 
|  | s->group_statement.children.head); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_data_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_reloc_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_object_symbols_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_output_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_target_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_input_section_enum: | 
|  | case lang_input_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_assignment_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_padding_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_address_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_fill_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_insert_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | FAIL (); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_for_each_statement (void (*func) (lang_statement_union_type *)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_for_each_statement_worker (func, statement_list.head); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /*----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_list_init (lang_statement_list_type *list) | 
|  | { | 
|  | list->head = NULL; | 
|  | list->tail = &list->head; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_statement_append (lang_statement_list_type *list, | 
|  | void *element, | 
|  | void *field) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *(list->tail) = element; | 
|  | list->tail = field; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | push_stat_ptr (lang_statement_list_type *new_ptr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (stat_save_ptr >= stat_save + sizeof (stat_save) / sizeof (stat_save[0])) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | *stat_save_ptr++ = stat_ptr; | 
|  | stat_ptr = new_ptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | pop_stat_ptr (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (stat_save_ptr <= stat_save) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | stat_ptr = *--stat_save_ptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Build a new statement node for the parse tree.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_statement_union_type * | 
|  | new_statement (enum statement_enum type, | 
|  | size_t size, | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type *list) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type *new_stmt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_stmt = stat_alloc (size); | 
|  | new_stmt->header.type = type; | 
|  | new_stmt->header.next = NULL; | 
|  | lang_statement_append (list, new_stmt, &new_stmt->header.next); | 
|  | return new_stmt; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Build a new input file node for the language.  There are several | 
|  | ways in which we treat an input file, eg, we only look at symbols, | 
|  | or prefix it with a -l etc. | 
|  |  | 
|  | We can be supplied with requests for input files more than once; | 
|  | they may, for example be split over several lines like foo.o(.text) | 
|  | foo.o(.data) etc, so when asked for a file we check that we haven't | 
|  | got it already so we don't duplicate the bfd.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_input_statement_type * | 
|  | new_afile (const char *name, | 
|  | lang_input_file_enum_type file_type, | 
|  | const char *target, | 
|  | const char *from_filename) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *p; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_has_input_file = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* PR 30632: It is OK for name to be NULL.  For example | 
|  | see the initialization of first_file in lang_init().  */ | 
|  | if (name != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | name = ldfile_possibly_remap_input (name); | 
|  | /* But if a name is remapped to NULL, it should be ignored.  */ | 
|  | if (name == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | p = new_stat (lang_input_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  | memset (&p->the_bfd, 0, | 
|  | sizeof (*p) - offsetof (lang_input_statement_type, the_bfd)); | 
|  | p->extra_search_path = NULL; | 
|  | p->target = target; | 
|  | p->flags.dynamic = input_flags.dynamic; | 
|  | p->flags.add_DT_NEEDED_for_dynamic = input_flags.add_DT_NEEDED_for_dynamic; | 
|  | p->flags.add_DT_NEEDED_for_regular = input_flags.add_DT_NEEDED_for_regular; | 
|  | p->flags.whole_archive = input_flags.whole_archive; | 
|  | p->flags.sysrooted = input_flags.sysrooted; | 
|  | p->sort_key = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (file_type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_input_file_is_symbols_only_enum: | 
|  | p->filename = name; | 
|  | p->local_sym_name = name; | 
|  | p->flags.real = true; | 
|  | p->flags.just_syms = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_file_is_fake_enum: | 
|  | p->filename = name; | 
|  | p->local_sym_name = name; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_file_is_l_enum: | 
|  | if (name[0] == ':' && name[1] != '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | p->filename = name + 1; | 
|  | p->flags.full_name_provided = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | p->filename = name; | 
|  | p->local_sym_name = concat ("-l", name, (const char *) NULL); | 
|  | p->flags.maybe_archive = true; | 
|  | p->flags.real = true; | 
|  | p->flags.search_dirs = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_file_is_marker_enum: | 
|  | p->filename = name; | 
|  | p->local_sym_name = name; | 
|  | p->flags.search_dirs = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_file_is_search_file_enum: | 
|  | p->filename = name; | 
|  | p->local_sym_name = name; | 
|  | /* If name is a relative path, search the directory of the current linker | 
|  | script first. */ | 
|  | if (from_filename && !IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (name)) | 
|  | p->extra_search_path = ldirname (from_filename); | 
|  | p->flags.real = true; | 
|  | p->flags.search_dirs = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_file_is_file_enum: | 
|  | p->filename = name; | 
|  | p->local_sym_name = name; | 
|  | p->flags.real = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | FAIL (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_statement_append (&input_file_chain, p, &p->next_real_file); | 
|  | return p; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type * | 
|  | lang_add_input_file (const char *name, | 
|  | lang_input_file_enum_type file_type, | 
|  | const char *target) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (name != NULL | 
|  | && (*name == '=' || startswith (name, "$SYSROOT"))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *ret; | 
|  | char *sysrooted_name | 
|  | = concat (ld_sysroot, | 
|  | name + (*name == '=' ? 1 : strlen ("$SYSROOT")), | 
|  | (const char *) NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We've now forcibly prepended the sysroot, making the input | 
|  | file independent of the context.  Therefore, temporarily | 
|  | force a non-sysrooted context for this statement, so it won't | 
|  | get the sysroot prepended again when opened.  (N.B. if it's a | 
|  | script, any child nodes with input files starting with "/" | 
|  | will be handled as "sysrooted" as they'll be found to be | 
|  | within the sysroot subdirectory.)  */ | 
|  | unsigned int outer_sysrooted = input_flags.sysrooted; | 
|  | input_flags.sysrooted = 0; | 
|  | ret = new_afile (sysrooted_name, file_type, target, NULL); | 
|  | input_flags.sysrooted = outer_sysrooted; | 
|  | return ret; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return new_afile (name, file_type, target, current_input_file); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct out_section_hash_entry | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_hash_entry root; | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type s; | 
|  | struct out_section_hash_entry *tail; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The hash table.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bfd_hash_table output_section_statement_table; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Support routines for the hash table used by lang_output_section_find, | 
|  | initialize the table, fill in an entry and remove the table.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct out_section_hash_entry * | 
|  | output_section_statement_newfunc_1 (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry, | 
|  | struct bfd_hash_table *table, | 
|  | const char *string) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type **nextp; | 
|  | struct out_section_hash_entry *ret; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (entry == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | entry = (struct bfd_hash_entry *) bfd_hash_allocate (table, | 
|  | sizeof (*ret)); | 
|  | if (entry == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string); | 
|  | if (entry == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ret = (struct out_section_hash_entry *) entry; | 
|  | memset (&ret->s, 0, sizeof (ret->s)); | 
|  | ret->s.header.type = lang_output_section_statement_enum; | 
|  | ret->s.output_section_statement.subsection_alignment = NULL; | 
|  | ret->s.output_section_statement.section_alignment = NULL; | 
|  | ret->s.output_section_statement.block_value = 1; | 
|  | lang_list_init (&ret->s.output_section_statement.children); | 
|  | lang_list_init (&ret->s.output_section_statement.sort_children); | 
|  | lang_statement_append (stat_ptr, &ret->s, &ret->s.header.next); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For every output section statement added to the list, except the | 
|  | first one, lang_os_list.tail points to the "next" | 
|  | field of the last element of the list.  */ | 
|  | if (lang_os_list.head != NULL) | 
|  | ret->s.output_section_statement.prev | 
|  | = ((lang_output_section_statement_type *) | 
|  | ((char *) lang_os_list.tail | 
|  | - offsetof (lang_output_section_statement_type, next))); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* GCC's strict aliasing rules prevent us from just casting the | 
|  | address, so we store the pointer in a variable and cast that | 
|  | instead.  */ | 
|  | nextp = &ret->s.output_section_statement.next; | 
|  | lang_statement_append (&lang_os_list, &ret->s, nextp); | 
|  | return ret; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bfd_hash_entry * | 
|  | output_section_statement_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry, | 
|  | struct bfd_hash_table *table, | 
|  | const char *string) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct out_section_hash_entry *ret; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ret = output_section_statement_newfunc_1 (entry, table, string); | 
|  | if (ret == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | ret->tail = ret; | 
|  | return &ret->root; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | output_section_statement_table_init (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!bfd_hash_table_init_n (&output_section_statement_table, | 
|  | output_section_statement_newfunc, | 
|  | sizeof (struct out_section_hash_entry), | 
|  | 61)) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: can not create hash table: %E\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | output_section_statement_table_free (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_hash_table_free (&output_section_statement_table); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Build enough state so that the parser can build its tree.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_init (bool object_only) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!object_only) | 
|  | { | 
|  | obstack_begin (&stat_obstack, 1000); | 
|  | obstack_init (&pt_obstack); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | stat_ptr = &statement_list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | output_section_statement_table_init (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | cmdline_lists_init (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_list_init (stat_ptr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_list_init (&input_file_chain); | 
|  | lang_list_init (&lang_os_list); | 
|  | lang_list_init (&file_chain); | 
|  | first_file = lang_add_input_file (NULL, lang_input_file_is_marker_enum, | 
|  | NULL); | 
|  | abs_output_section = | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_lookup (BFD_ABS_SECTION_NAME, 0, 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | abs_output_section->bfd_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | asneeded_list_head = NULL; | 
|  | asneeded_list_tail = &asneeded_list_head; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_finish (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | output_section_statement_table_free (); | 
|  | ldfile_free (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /*---------------------------------------------------------------------- | 
|  | A region is an area of memory declared with the | 
|  | MEMORY {  name:org=exp, len=exp ... } | 
|  | syntax. | 
|  |  | 
|  | We maintain a list of all the regions here. | 
|  |  | 
|  | If no regions are specified in the script, then the default is used | 
|  | which is created when looked up to be the entire data space. | 
|  |  | 
|  | If create is true we are creating a region inside a MEMORY block. | 
|  | In this case it is probably an error to create a region that has | 
|  | already been created.  If we are not inside a MEMORY block it is | 
|  | dubious to use an undeclared region name (except DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION) | 
|  | and so we issue a warning. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Each region has at least one name.  The first name is either | 
|  | DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION or the name given in the MEMORY block.  You can add | 
|  | alias names to an existing region within a script with | 
|  | REGION_ALIAS (alias, region_name).  Each name corresponds to at most one | 
|  | region.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_memory_region_type *lang_memory_region_list; | 
|  | static lang_memory_region_type **lang_memory_region_list_tail | 
|  | = &lang_memory_region_list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type * | 
|  | lang_memory_region_lookup (const char *const name, bool create) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_memory_region_name *n; | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *r; | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *new_region; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* NAME is NULL for LMA memspecs if no region was specified.  */ | 
|  | if (name == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (r = lang_memory_region_list; r != NULL; r = r->next) | 
|  | for (n = &r->name_list; n != NULL; n = n->next) | 
|  | if (strcmp (n->name, name) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (create) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P:%pS: warning: redeclaration of memory region `%s'\n"), | 
|  | NULL, name); | 
|  | return r; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!create && strcmp (name, DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION)) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P:%pS: warning: memory region `%s' not declared\n"), | 
|  | NULL, name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_region = stat_alloc (sizeof (lang_memory_region_type)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_region->name_list.name = stat_strdup (name); | 
|  | new_region->name_list.next = NULL; | 
|  | new_region->next = NULL; | 
|  | new_region->origin_exp = NULL; | 
|  | new_region->origin = 0; | 
|  | new_region->length_exp = NULL; | 
|  | new_region->length = ~(bfd_size_type) 0; | 
|  | new_region->current = 0; | 
|  | new_region->last_os = NULL; | 
|  | new_region->flags = 0; | 
|  | new_region->not_flags = 0; | 
|  | new_region->had_full_message = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | *lang_memory_region_list_tail = new_region; | 
|  | lang_memory_region_list_tail = &new_region->next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return new_region; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_memory_region_alias (const char *alias, const char *region_name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_memory_region_name *n; | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *r; | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *region; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The default region must be unique.  This ensures that it is not necessary | 
|  | to iterate through the name list if someone wants the check if a region is | 
|  | the default memory region.  */ | 
|  | if (strcmp (region_name, DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION) == 0 | 
|  | || strcmp (alias, DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION) == 0) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P:%pS: error: alias for default memory region\n"), NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look for the target region and check if the alias is not already | 
|  | in use.  */ | 
|  | region = NULL; | 
|  | for (r = lang_memory_region_list; r != NULL; r = r->next) | 
|  | for (n = &r->name_list; n != NULL; n = n->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (region == NULL && strcmp (n->name, region_name) == 0) | 
|  | region = r; | 
|  | if (strcmp (n->name, alias) == 0) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P:%pS: error: redefinition of memory region " | 
|  | "alias `%s'\n"), | 
|  | NULL, alias); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check if the target region exists.  */ | 
|  | if (region == NULL) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P:%pS: error: memory region `%s' " | 
|  | "for alias `%s' does not exist\n"), | 
|  | NULL, region_name, alias); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add alias to region name list.  */ | 
|  | n = stat_alloc (sizeof (lang_memory_region_name)); | 
|  | n->name = stat_strdup (alias); | 
|  | n->next = region->name_list.next; | 
|  | region->name_list.next = n; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_memory_region_type * | 
|  | lang_memory_default (asection *section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *p; | 
|  |  | 
|  | flagword sec_flags = section->flags; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Override SEC_DATA to mean a writable section.  */ | 
|  | if ((sec_flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_READONLY | SEC_CODE)) == SEC_ALLOC) | 
|  | sec_flags |= SEC_DATA; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (p = lang_memory_region_list; p != NULL; p = p->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if ((p->flags & sec_flags) != 0 | 
|  | && (p->not_flags & sec_flags) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return p; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return lang_memory_region_lookup (DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION, false); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Get the output section statement directly from the userdata.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type * | 
|  | lang_output_section_get (const asection *output_section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | return bfd_section_userdata (output_section); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find or create an output_section_statement with the given NAME. | 
|  | If CONSTRAINT is non-zero match one with that constraint, otherwise | 
|  | match any non-negative constraint.  If CREATE is 0 return NULL when | 
|  | no match exists.  If CREATE is 1, create an output_section_statement | 
|  | when no match exists or if CONSTRAINT is SPECIAL.  If CREATE is 2, | 
|  | always make a new output_section_statement.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type * | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_lookup (const char *name, | 
|  | int constraint, | 
|  | int create) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct out_section_hash_entry *entry; | 
|  |  | 
|  | entry = ((struct out_section_hash_entry *) | 
|  | bfd_hash_lookup (&output_section_statement_table, name, | 
|  | create != 0, false)); | 
|  | if (entry == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (create) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: failed creating section `%s': %E\n"), name); | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (entry->s.output_section_statement.name != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We have a section of this name, but it might not have the correct | 
|  | constraint.  */ | 
|  | struct out_section_hash_entry *first_ent = entry; | 
|  | struct out_section_hash_entry *last_ent; | 
|  |  | 
|  | name = entry->s.output_section_statement.name; | 
|  | if (create != 2 | 
|  | && !(create && constraint == SPECIAL)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | do | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (constraint == entry->s.output_section_statement.constraint | 
|  | || (constraint == 0 | 
|  | && entry->s.output_section_statement.constraint >= 0)) | 
|  | return &entry->s.output_section_statement; | 
|  | last_ent = entry; | 
|  | entry = (struct out_section_hash_entry *) entry->root.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | while (entry != NULL | 
|  | && name == entry->s.output_section_statement.name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | last_ent = first_ent->tail; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!create) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Only the first entry needs the tail pointer.  */ | 
|  | entry = bfd_hash_allocate (&output_section_statement_table, | 
|  | offsetof (struct out_section_hash_entry, tail)); | 
|  | if (entry != NULL) | 
|  | entry | 
|  | = output_section_statement_newfunc_1 (&entry->root, | 
|  | &output_section_statement_table, | 
|  | name); | 
|  | if (entry == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: failed creating section `%s': %E\n"), name); | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | entry->root = last_ent->root; | 
|  | last_ent->root.next = &entry->root; | 
|  | first_ent->tail = entry; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | entry->s.output_section_statement.name = name; | 
|  | entry->s.output_section_statement.constraint = constraint; | 
|  | entry->s.output_section_statement.dup_output = (create == 2 | 
|  | || constraint == SPECIAL); | 
|  | return &entry->s.output_section_statement; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find the next output_section_statement with the same name as OS. | 
|  | If CONSTRAINT is non-zero, find one with that constraint otherwise | 
|  | match any non-negative constraint.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type * | 
|  | next_matching_output_section_statement (lang_output_section_statement_type *os, | 
|  | int constraint) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* All output_section_statements are actually part of a | 
|  | struct out_section_hash_entry.  */ | 
|  | struct out_section_hash_entry *entry = (struct out_section_hash_entry *) | 
|  | ((char *) os | 
|  | - offsetof (struct out_section_hash_entry, s.output_section_statement)); | 
|  | const char *name = os->name; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASSERT (name == entry->root.string); | 
|  | do | 
|  | { | 
|  | entry = (struct out_section_hash_entry *) entry->root.next; | 
|  | if (entry == NULL | 
|  | || name != entry->s.output_section_statement.name) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | while (constraint != entry->s.output_section_statement.constraint | 
|  | && (constraint != 0 | 
|  | || entry->s.output_section_statement.constraint < 0)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return &entry->s.output_section_statement; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A variant of lang_output_section_find used by place_orphan. | 
|  | Returns the output statement that should precede a new output | 
|  | statement for SEC.  If an exact match is found on certain flags, | 
|  | sets *EXACT too.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type * | 
|  | lang_output_section_find_by_flags (const asection *sec, | 
|  | flagword sec_flags, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type **exact, | 
|  | lang_match_sec_type_func match_type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *first, *look, *found; | 
|  | flagword look_flags, differ; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We know the first statement on this list is *ABS*.  May as well | 
|  | skip it.  */ | 
|  | first = (void *) lang_os_list.head; | 
|  | first = first->next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* First try for an exact match.  */ | 
|  | found = NULL; | 
|  | for (look = first; look; look = look->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->flags; | 
|  | if (look->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->bfd_section->flags; | 
|  | if (match_type && !match_type (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | look->bfd_section, | 
|  | sec->owner, sec)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | differ = look_flags ^ sec_flags; | 
|  | if (!(differ & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | 
|  | | SEC_CODE | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))) | 
|  | found = look; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (found != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (exact != NULL) | 
|  | *exact = found; | 
|  | return found; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((sec_flags & SEC_CODE) != 0 | 
|  | && (sec_flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Try for a rw code section.  */ | 
|  | for (look = first; look; look = look->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->flags; | 
|  | if (look->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->bfd_section->flags; | 
|  | if (match_type && !match_type (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | look->bfd_section, | 
|  | sec->owner, sec)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | differ = look_flags ^ sec_flags; | 
|  | if (!(differ & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | 
|  | | SEC_CODE | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))) | 
|  | found = look; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if ((sec_flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0 | 
|  | && (sec_flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* .rodata can go after .text, .sdata2 after .rodata.  */ | 
|  | for (look = first; look; look = look->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->flags; | 
|  | if (look->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->bfd_section->flags; | 
|  | if (match_type && !match_type (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | look->bfd_section, | 
|  | sec->owner, sec)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | differ = look_flags ^ sec_flags; | 
|  | if (!(differ & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | 
|  | | SEC_READONLY | SEC_SMALL_DATA)) | 
|  | || (!(differ & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | 
|  | | SEC_READONLY)) | 
|  | && !(look_flags & SEC_SMALL_DATA))) | 
|  | found = look; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if ((sec_flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0 | 
|  | && (sec_flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* .tdata can go after .data, .tbss after .tdata.  Treat .tbss | 
|  | as if it were a loaded section, and don't use match_type.  */ | 
|  | bool seen_thread_local = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | match_type = NULL; | 
|  | for (look = first; look; look = look->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->flags; | 
|  | if (look->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | look_flags = look->bfd_section->flags; | 
|  |  | 
|  | differ = look_flags ^ (sec_flags | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS); | 
|  | if (!(differ & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_ALLOC))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* .tdata and .tbss must be adjacent and in that order.  */ | 
|  | if (!(look_flags & SEC_LOAD) | 
|  | && (sec_flags & SEC_LOAD)) | 
|  | /* ..so if we're at a .tbss section and we're placing | 
|  | a .tdata section stop looking and return the | 
|  | previous section.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  | found = look; | 
|  | seen_thread_local = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (seen_thread_local) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | else if (!(differ & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD))) | 
|  | found = look; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if ((sec_flags & SEC_SMALL_DATA) != 0 | 
|  | && (sec_flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* .sdata goes after .data, .sbss after .sdata.  */ | 
|  | for (look = first; look; look = look->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->flags; | 
|  | if (look->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->bfd_section->flags; | 
|  | if (match_type && !match_type (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | look->bfd_section, | 
|  | sec->owner, sec)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | differ = look_flags ^ sec_flags; | 
|  | if (!(differ & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | 
|  | | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) | 
|  | || ((look_flags & SEC_SMALL_DATA) | 
|  | && !(sec_flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))) | 
|  | found = look; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if ((sec_flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 | 
|  | && (sec_flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* .data goes after .rodata.  */ | 
|  | for (look = first; look; look = look->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->flags; | 
|  | if (look->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->bfd_section->flags; | 
|  | if (match_type && !match_type (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | look->bfd_section, | 
|  | sec->owner, sec)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | differ = look_flags ^ sec_flags; | 
|  | if (!(differ & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | 
|  | | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))) | 
|  | found = look; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if ((sec_flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* .bss goes after any other alloc section.  */ | 
|  | for (look = first; look; look = look->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->flags; | 
|  | if (look->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->bfd_section->flags; | 
|  | if (match_type && !match_type (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | look->bfd_section, | 
|  | sec->owner, sec)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | differ = look_flags ^ sec_flags; | 
|  | if (!(differ & SEC_ALLOC)) | 
|  | found = look; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* non-alloc go last.  */ | 
|  | for (look = first; look; look = look->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | look_flags = look->flags; | 
|  | if (look->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | look_flags = look->bfd_section->flags; | 
|  | differ = look_flags ^ sec_flags; | 
|  | if (!(differ & SEC_DEBUGGING)) | 
|  | found = look; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return found; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (found || !match_type) | 
|  | return found; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return lang_output_section_find_by_flags (sec, sec_flags, NULL, NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find the last output section before given output statement. | 
|  | Used by place_orphan.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static asection * | 
|  | output_prev_sec_find (lang_output_section_statement_type *os) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *lookup; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (lookup = os->prev; lookup != NULL; lookup = lookup->prev) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (lookup->constraint < 0) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (lookup->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | return lookup->bfd_section; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look for a suitable place for a new output section statement.  The | 
|  | idea is to skip over anything that might be inside a SECTIONS {} | 
|  | statement in a script, before we find another output section | 
|  | statement.  Assignments to "dot" before an output section statement | 
|  | are assumed to belong to it, except in two cases;  The first | 
|  | assignment to dot, and assignments before non-alloc sections. | 
|  | Otherwise we might put an orphan before . = . + SIZEOF_HEADERS or | 
|  | similar assignments that set the initial address, or we might | 
|  | insert non-alloc note sections among assignments setting end of | 
|  | image symbols.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_statement_union_type ** | 
|  | insert_os_after (lang_statement_union_type *after) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **where; | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **assign = NULL; | 
|  | bool ignore_first; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ignore_first = after == lang_os_list.head; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (where = &after->header.next; | 
|  | *where != NULL; | 
|  | where = &(*where)->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch ((*where)->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_assignment_statement_enum: | 
|  | if (assign == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_assignment_statement_type *ass; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ass = &(*where)->assignment_statement; | 
|  | if (ass->exp->type.node_class != etree_assert | 
|  | && ass->exp->assign.dst[0] == '.' | 
|  | && ass->exp->assign.dst[1] == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!ignore_first) | 
|  | assign = where; | 
|  | ignore_first = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_input_section_enum: | 
|  | case lang_object_symbols_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_fill_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_data_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_reloc_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_padding_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | assign = NULL; | 
|  | ignore_first = false; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | if (assign != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *s = (*where)->output_section_statement.bfd_section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (s == NULL | 
|  | || s->map_head.s == NULL | 
|  | || (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) | 
|  | where = assign; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_address_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_target_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_output_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_insert_statement_enum: | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | case lang_input_matcher_enum: | 
|  | FAIL (); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return where; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type * | 
|  | lang_insert_orphan (asection *s, | 
|  | const char *secname, | 
|  | int constraint, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *after, | 
|  | struct orphan_save *place, | 
|  | etree_type *address, | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type *add_child) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type add; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type **os_tail; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have found an appropriate place for the output section | 
|  | statements for this orphan, add them to our own private list, | 
|  | inserting them later into the global statement list.  */ | 
|  | if (after != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_list_init (&add); | 
|  | push_stat_ptr (&add); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) | 
|  | || (s->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_ALLOC)) == 0) | 
|  | address = exp_intop (0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | os_tail = (lang_output_section_statement_type **) lang_os_list.tail; | 
|  | os = lang_enter_output_section_statement ( | 
|  | secname, address, normal_section, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, constraint, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (add_child == NULL) | 
|  | add_child = &os->children; | 
|  | lang_add_section (add_child, s, NULL, NULL, os); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (after && (s->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_ALLOC)) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *region = (after->region | 
|  | ? after->region->name_list.name | 
|  | : DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION); | 
|  | const char *lma_region = (after->lma_region | 
|  | ? after->lma_region->name_list.name | 
|  | : NULL); | 
|  | lang_leave_output_section_statement (NULL, region, after->phdrs, | 
|  | lma_region); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | lang_leave_output_section_statement (NULL, DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION, NULL, | 
|  | NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Restore the global list pointer.  */ | 
|  | if (after != NULL) | 
|  | pop_stat_ptr (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (after != NULL && os->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *snew, *as; | 
|  | bool place_after = place->stmt == NULL; | 
|  | bool insert_after = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | snew = os->bfd_section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Shuffle the bfd section list to make the output file look | 
|  | neater.  This is really only cosmetic.  */ | 
|  | if (place->section == NULL | 
|  | && after != (void *) lang_os_list.head) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *bfd_section = after->bfd_section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If the output statement hasn't been used to place any input | 
|  | sections (and thus doesn't have an output bfd_section), | 
|  | look for the closest prior output statement having an | 
|  | output section.  */ | 
|  | if (bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | bfd_section = output_prev_sec_find (after); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bfd_section != NULL | 
|  | && bfd_section->owner != NULL | 
|  | && bfd_section != snew) | 
|  | place->section = &bfd_section->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (place->section == NULL) | 
|  | place->section = &link_info.output_bfd->sections; | 
|  |  | 
|  | as = *place->section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!as) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Put the section at the end of the list.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Unlink the section.  */ | 
|  | bfd_section_list_remove (link_info.output_bfd, snew); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now tack it back on in the right place.  */ | 
|  | bfd_section_list_append (link_info.output_bfd, snew); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if ((bfd_get_flavour (link_info.output_bfd) | 
|  | == bfd_target_elf_flavour) | 
|  | && (bfd_get_flavour (s->owner) | 
|  | == bfd_target_elf_flavour) | 
|  | && ((elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE | 
|  | && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0) | 
|  | || (elf_section_type (as) == SHT_NOTE | 
|  | && (as->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Make sure that output note sections are grouped and sorted | 
|  | by alignments when inserting a note section or insert a | 
|  | section after a note section,  */ | 
|  | asection *sec; | 
|  | /* A specific section after which the output note section | 
|  | should be placed.  */ | 
|  | asection *after_sec; | 
|  | /* True if we need to insert the orphan section after a | 
|  | specific section to maintain output note section order.  */ | 
|  | bool after_sec_note = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static asection *first_orphan_note = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Group and sort output note section by alignments in | 
|  | ascending order.  */ | 
|  | after_sec = NULL; | 
|  | if (elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE | 
|  | && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Search from the beginning for the last output note | 
|  | section with equal or larger alignments.  NB: Don't | 
|  | place orphan note section after non-note sections.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | first_orphan_note = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* NB: When --rosegment is used, the .note.gnu.build-id | 
|  | section is placed before text sections.  Ignore the | 
|  | .note.gnu.build-id section if -z separate-code and | 
|  | --rosegment are used together to avoid putting any | 
|  | note sections between the .note.gnu.build-id section | 
|  | and text sections in the same PT_LOAD segment.  */ | 
|  | bool ignore_build_id = (link_info.separate_code | 
|  | && link_info.one_rosegment); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (sec = link_info.output_bfd->sections; | 
|  | (sec != NULL | 
|  | && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec)); | 
|  | sec = sec->next) | 
|  | if (sec != snew | 
|  | && elf_section_type (sec) == SHT_NOTE | 
|  | && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 | 
|  | && (!ignore_build_id | 
|  | || strcmp (sec->name, ".note.gnu.build-id") != 0)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!first_orphan_note) | 
|  | first_orphan_note = sec; | 
|  | if (sec->alignment_power >= s->alignment_power) | 
|  | after_sec = sec; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (first_orphan_note) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Stop if there is non-note section after the first | 
|  | orphan note section.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this will be the first orphan note section, it can | 
|  | be placed at the default location.  */ | 
|  | after_sec_note = first_orphan_note != NULL; | 
|  | if (after_sec == NULL && after_sec_note) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If all output note sections have smaller | 
|  | alignments, place the section before all | 
|  | output orphan note sections.  */ | 
|  | after_sec = first_orphan_note; | 
|  | insert_after = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (first_orphan_note) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Don't place non-note sections in the middle of orphan | 
|  | note sections.  */ | 
|  | after_sec_note = true; | 
|  | after_sec = as; | 
|  | for (sec = as->next; | 
|  | (sec != NULL | 
|  | && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec)); | 
|  | sec = sec->next) | 
|  | if (elf_section_type (sec) == SHT_NOTE | 
|  | && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0) | 
|  | after_sec = sec; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (after_sec_note) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (after_sec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Search forward to insert OS after AFTER_SEC output | 
|  | statement.  */ | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *stmt, *next; | 
|  | bool found = false; | 
|  | for (stmt = after; stmt != NULL; stmt = next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | next = stmt->next; | 
|  | if (insert_after) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (stmt->bfd_section == after_sec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | place_after = true; | 
|  | found = true; | 
|  | after = stmt; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If INSERT_AFTER is FALSE, place OS before | 
|  | AFTER_SEC output statement.  */ | 
|  | if (next && next->bfd_section == after_sec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | place_after = true; | 
|  | found = true; | 
|  | after = stmt; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Search backward to insert OS after AFTER_SEC output | 
|  | statement.  */ | 
|  | if (!found) | 
|  | for (stmt = after; stmt != NULL; stmt = stmt->prev) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (insert_after) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (stmt->bfd_section == after_sec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | place_after = true; | 
|  | after = stmt; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If INSERT_AFTER is FALSE, place OS before | 
|  | AFTER_SEC output statement.  */ | 
|  | if (stmt->next->bfd_section == after_sec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | place_after = true; | 
|  | after = stmt; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (after_sec == NULL | 
|  | || (insert_after && after_sec->next != snew) | 
|  | || (!insert_after && after_sec->prev != snew)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Unlink the section.  */ | 
|  | bfd_section_list_remove (link_info.output_bfd, snew); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Place SNEW after AFTER_SEC.  If AFTER_SEC is NULL, | 
|  | prepend SNEW.  */ | 
|  | if (after_sec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (insert_after) | 
|  | bfd_section_list_insert_after (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | after_sec, snew); | 
|  | else | 
|  | bfd_section_list_insert_before (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | after_sec, snew); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | bfd_section_list_prepend (link_info.output_bfd, snew); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (as != snew && as->prev != snew) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Unlink the section.  */ | 
|  | bfd_section_list_remove (link_info.output_bfd, snew); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now tack it back on in the right place.  */ | 
|  | bfd_section_list_insert_before (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | as, snew); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (as != snew && as->prev != snew) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Unlink the section.  */ | 
|  | bfd_section_list_remove (link_info.output_bfd, snew); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now tack it back on in the right place.  */ | 
|  | bfd_section_list_insert_before (link_info.output_bfd, as, snew); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Save the end of this list.  Further ophans of this type will | 
|  | follow the one we've just added.  */ | 
|  | place->section = &snew->next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The following is non-cosmetic.  We try to put the output | 
|  | statements in some sort of reasonable order here, because they | 
|  | determine the final load addresses of the orphan sections. | 
|  | In addition, placing output statements in the wrong order may | 
|  | require extra segments.  For instance, given a typical | 
|  | situation of all read-only sections placed in one segment and | 
|  | following that a segment containing all the read-write | 
|  | sections, we wouldn't want to place an orphan read/write | 
|  | section before or amongst the read-only ones.  */ | 
|  | if (add.head != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *newly_added_os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Place OS after AFTER if AFTER_NOTE is TRUE.  */ | 
|  | if (place_after) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **where; | 
|  |  | 
|  | where = insert_os_after ((lang_statement_union_type *) after); | 
|  | *add.tail = *where; | 
|  | *where = add.head; | 
|  |  | 
|  | place->os_tail = &after->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Put it after the last orphan statement we added.  */ | 
|  | *add.tail = *place->stmt; | 
|  | *place->stmt = add.head; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Fix the global list pointer if we happened to tack our | 
|  | new list at the tail.  */ | 
|  | if (*stat_ptr->tail == add.head) | 
|  | stat_ptr->tail = add.tail; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Save the end of this list.  */ | 
|  | place->stmt = add.tail; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do the same for the list of output section statements.  */ | 
|  | newly_added_os = *os_tail; | 
|  | *os_tail = NULL; | 
|  | newly_added_os->prev = (lang_output_section_statement_type *) | 
|  | ((char *) place->os_tail | 
|  | - offsetof (lang_output_section_statement_type, next)); | 
|  | newly_added_os->next = *place->os_tail; | 
|  | if (newly_added_os->next != NULL) | 
|  | newly_added_os->next->prev = newly_added_os; | 
|  | *place->os_tail = newly_added_os; | 
|  | place->os_tail = &newly_added_os->next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Fixing the global list pointer here is a little different. | 
|  | We added to the list in lang_enter_output_section_statement, | 
|  | trimmed off the new output_section_statment above when | 
|  | assigning *os_tail = NULL, but possibly added it back in | 
|  | the same place when assigning *place->os_tail.  */ | 
|  | if (*os_tail == NULL) | 
|  | lang_os_list.tail = (lang_statement_union_type **) os_tail; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return os; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_print_asneeded (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct asneeded_minfo *m; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (asneeded_list_head == NULL) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | minfo (_("\nAs-needed library included to satisfy reference by file (symbol)\n\n")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (m = asneeded_list_head; m != NULL; m = m->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | minfo ("%s", m->soname); | 
|  | len = strlen (m->soname); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (len >= 29) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  | len = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | print_spaces (30 - len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (m->ref != NULL) | 
|  | minfo ("%pB ", m->ref); | 
|  | minfo ("(%pT)\n", m->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_map_flags (flagword flag) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (flag & SEC_ALLOC) | 
|  | minfo ("a"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (flag & SEC_CODE) | 
|  | minfo ("x"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (flag & SEC_READONLY) | 
|  | minfo ("r"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (flag & SEC_DATA) | 
|  | minfo ("w"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (flag & SEC_LOAD) | 
|  | minfo ("l"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_map (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *m; | 
|  | bool dis_header_printed = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldfile_print_input_remaps (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((file->the_bfd->flags & (BFD_LINKER_CREATED | DYNAMIC)) != 0 | 
|  | || file->flags.just_syms) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.print_map_discarded) | 
|  | for (s = file->the_bfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) | 
|  | if ((s->output_section == NULL | 
|  | || s->output_section->owner != link_info.output_bfd) | 
|  | && (s->flags & (SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_KEEP)) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (! dis_header_printed) | 
|  | { | 
|  | minfo (_("\nDiscarded input sections\n\n")); | 
|  | dis_header_printed = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_input_section (s, true); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (config.print_map_discarded && ! dis_header_printed) | 
|  | minfo (_("\nThere are no discarded input sections\n")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | minfo (_("\nMemory Configuration\n\n")); | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, "%-16s %-18s %-18s %s\n", | 
|  | _("Name"), _("Origin"), _("Length"), _("Attributes")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (m = lang_memory_region_list; m != NULL; m = m->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, "%-16s", m->name_list.name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | char buf[32]; | 
|  | bfd_sprintf_vma (link_info.output_bfd, buf, m->origin); | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, " 0x%-16s", buf); | 
|  | bfd_sprintf_vma (link_info.output_bfd, buf, m->length); | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, | 
|  | " 0x%*s", m->flags || m->not_flags ? -17 : 0, buf); | 
|  | if (m->flags) | 
|  | lang_map_flags (m->flags); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (m->not_flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | minfo ("!"); | 
|  | lang_map_flags (m->not_flags); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | minfo (_("\nLinker script and memory map\n\n")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!link_info.reduce_memory_overheads) | 
|  | { | 
|  | obstack_begin (&map_obstack, 1000); | 
|  | bfd_link_hash_traverse (link_info.hash, sort_def_symbol, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  | expld.phase = lang_fixed_phase_enum; | 
|  | lang_statement_iteration++; | 
|  | print_statements (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_extra_map_file_text (link_info.output_bfd, &link_info, | 
|  | config.map_file); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | sort_def_symbol (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *hash_entry, | 
|  | void *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if ((hash_entry->type == bfd_link_hash_defined | 
|  | || hash_entry->type == bfd_link_hash_defweak) | 
|  | && hash_entry->u.def.section->owner != link_info.output_bfd | 
|  | && hash_entry->u.def.section->owner != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | input_section_userdata_type *ud; | 
|  | struct map_symbol_def *def; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ud = bfd_section_userdata (hash_entry->u.def.section); | 
|  | if (!ud) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ud = stat_alloc (sizeof (*ud)); | 
|  | bfd_set_section_userdata (hash_entry->u.def.section, ud); | 
|  | ud->map_symbol_def_tail = &ud->map_symbol_def_head; | 
|  | ud->map_symbol_def_count = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (!ud->map_symbol_def_tail) | 
|  | ud->map_symbol_def_tail = &ud->map_symbol_def_head; | 
|  |  | 
|  | def = (struct map_symbol_def *) obstack_alloc (&map_obstack, sizeof *def); | 
|  | def->entry = hash_entry; | 
|  | *(ud->map_symbol_def_tail) = def; | 
|  | ud->map_symbol_def_tail = &def->next; | 
|  | ud->map_symbol_def_count++; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Initialize an output section.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | init_os (lang_output_section_statement_type *s, flagword flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (strcmp (s->name, DISCARD_SECTION_NAME) == 0) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: illegal use of `%s' section\n"), DISCARD_SECTION_NAME); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!s->dup_output) | 
|  | s->bfd_section = bfd_get_section_by_name (link_info.output_bfd, s->name); | 
|  | if (s->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | s->bfd_section = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | s->name, flags); | 
|  | if (s->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: output format %s cannot represent section" | 
|  | " called %s: %E\n"), | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->xvec->name, s->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | s->bfd_section->output_section = s->bfd_section; | 
|  | s->bfd_section->output_offset = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the userdata of the output section to the output section | 
|  | statement to avoid lookup.  */ | 
|  | bfd_set_section_userdata (s->bfd_section, s); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If there is a base address, make sure that any sections it might | 
|  | mention are initialized.  */ | 
|  | if (s->addr_tree != NULL) | 
|  | exp_init_os (s->addr_tree); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (s->load_base != NULL) | 
|  | exp_init_os (s->load_base); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If supplied an alignment, set it.  */ | 
|  | if (s->section_alignment != NULL) | 
|  | s->bfd_section->alignment_power = exp_get_power (s->section_alignment, s, | 
|  | "section alignment"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static flagword | 
|  | get_os_init_flag (lang_output_section_statement_type * os) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (os != NULL) | 
|  | switch (os->sectype) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case readonly_section: return SEC_READONLY; | 
|  | case noload_section:   return SEC_NEVER_LOAD; | 
|  | default: break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure that all output sections mentioned in an expression are | 
|  | initialized.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | exp_init_os (etree_type *exp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (exp->type.node_class) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case etree_assign: | 
|  | case etree_provide: | 
|  | case etree_provided: | 
|  | exp_init_os (exp->assign.src); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case etree_binary: | 
|  | exp_init_os (exp->binary.lhs); | 
|  | exp_init_os (exp->binary.rhs); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case etree_trinary: | 
|  | exp_init_os (exp->trinary.cond); | 
|  | exp_init_os (exp->trinary.lhs); | 
|  | exp_init_os (exp->trinary.rhs); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case etree_assert: | 
|  | exp_init_os (exp->assert_s.child); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case etree_unary: | 
|  | exp_init_os (exp->unary.child); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case etree_name: | 
|  | switch (exp->type.node_code) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case ADDR: | 
|  | case LOADADDR: | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os = lang_output_section_find (exp->name.name); | 
|  | if (os != NULL && os->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | init_os (os, get_os_init_flag (os)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | section_already_linked (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *entry = (lang_input_statement_type *) data; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we are only reading symbols from this object, then we want to | 
|  | discard all sections.  */ | 
|  | if (entry->flags.just_syms) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_link_just_syms (abfd, sec, &link_info); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Deal with SHF_EXCLUDE ELF sections.  */ | 
|  | if (!bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) | 
|  | && (abfd->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) == 0 | 
|  | && (sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_KEEP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE) | 
|  | sec->output_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!(abfd->flags & DYNAMIC)) | 
|  | bfd_section_already_linked (abfd, sec, &link_info); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns true if SECTION is one we know will be discarded based on its | 
|  | section flags, otherwise returns false.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | lang_discard_section_p (asection *section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool discard; | 
|  | flagword flags = section->flags; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Discard sections marked with SEC_EXCLUDE.  */ | 
|  | discard = (flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Discard the group descriptor sections when we're finally placing the | 
|  | sections from within the group.  */ | 
|  | if ((flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0 | 
|  | && link_info.resolve_section_groups) | 
|  | discard = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Discard debugging sections if we are stripping debugging | 
|  | information.  */ | 
|  | if ((link_info.strip == strip_debugger || link_info.strip == strip_all) | 
|  | && (flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0) | 
|  | discard = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Discard non-alloc sections if we are stripping section headers.  */ | 
|  | else if (config.no_section_header && (flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0) | 
|  | discard = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return discard; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return TRUE if SECTION is never going to be added to output statement | 
|  | OUTPUT.  lang_add_section() definitely won't do anything with SECTION | 
|  | if this returns TRUE.  It may do something (or not) if this returns FALSE. | 
|  |  | 
|  | Can be used as early-out to filter matches.  This may set | 
|  | output_section of SECTION, if it was unset, to the abs section in case | 
|  | we discover SECTION to be always discarded.  This may also give | 
|  | warning messages.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | wont_add_section_p (asection *section, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *output) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool discard; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Is this section one we know should be discarded?  */ | 
|  | discard = lang_discard_section_p (section); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Discard input sections which are assigned to a section named | 
|  | DISCARD_SECTION_NAME.  */ | 
|  | if (strcmp (output->name, DISCARD_SECTION_NAME) == 0) | 
|  | discard = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (discard) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (section->output_section == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This prevents future calls from assigning this section or | 
|  | warning about it again.  */ | 
|  | section->output_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (bfd_is_abs_section (section->output_section)) | 
|  | ; | 
|  | else if (link_info.non_contiguous_regions_warnings) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P:%pS: warning: --enable-non-contiguous-regions makes " | 
|  | "section `%pA' from `%pB' match /DISCARD/ clause.\n"), | 
|  | NULL, section, section->owner); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (section->output_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!link_info.non_contiguous_regions) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* SECTION has already been handled in a special way | 
|  | (eg. LINK_ONCE): skip it.  */ | 
|  | if (bfd_is_abs_section (section->output_section)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Already assigned to the same output section, do not process | 
|  | it again, to avoid creating loops between duplicate sections | 
|  | later.  */ | 
|  | if (section->output_section == output->bfd_section) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.non_contiguous_regions_warnings && output->bfd_section) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P:%pS: warning: --enable-non-contiguous-regions may " | 
|  | "change behaviour for section `%pA' from `%pB' (assigned to " | 
|  | "%pA, but additional match: %pA)\n"), | 
|  | NULL, section, section->owner, section->output_section, | 
|  | output->bfd_section); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* SECTION has already been assigned to an output section, but | 
|  | the user allows it to be mapped to another one in case it | 
|  | overflows. We'll later update the actual output section in | 
|  | size_input_section as appropriate.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The wild routines. | 
|  |  | 
|  | These expand statements like *(.text) and foo.o to a list of | 
|  | explicit actions, like foo.o(.text), bar.o(.text) and | 
|  | foo.o(.text, .data).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add SECTION to the output section OUTPUT.  Do this by creating a | 
|  | lang_input_section statement which is placed at PTR.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_section (lang_statement_list_type *ptr, | 
|  | asection *section, | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *pattern, | 
|  | struct flag_info *sflag_info, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *output) | 
|  | { | 
|  | flagword flags = section->flags; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_input_section_type *new_section; | 
|  | bfd *abfd = link_info.output_bfd; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (wont_add_section_p (section, output)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sflag_info) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool keep; | 
|  |  | 
|  | keep = bfd_lookup_section_flags (&link_info, sflag_info, section); | 
|  | if (!keep) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We don't copy the SEC_NEVER_LOAD flag from an input section | 
|  | to an output section, because we want to be able to include a | 
|  | SEC_NEVER_LOAD section in the middle of an otherwise loaded | 
|  | section (I don't know why we want to do this, but we do). | 
|  | build_link_order in ldwrite.c handles this case by turning | 
|  | the embedded SEC_NEVER_LOAD section into a fill.  */ | 
|  | flags &= ~ SEC_NEVER_LOAD; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If final link, don't copy the SEC_LINK_ONCE flags, they've | 
|  | already been processed.  One reason to do this is that on pe | 
|  | format targets, .text$foo sections go into .text and it's odd | 
|  | to see .text with SEC_LINK_ONCE set.  */ | 
|  | if ((flags & (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_GROUP)) == (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_GROUP)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (link_info.resolve_section_groups) | 
|  | flags &= ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC); | 
|  | else | 
|  | flags &= ~(SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (!bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | flags &= ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC); | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (output->sectype) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case normal_section: | 
|  | case overlay_section: | 
|  | case first_overlay_section: | 
|  | case type_section: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case noalloc_section: | 
|  | flags &= ~SEC_ALLOC; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case typed_readonly_section: | 
|  | case readonly_section: | 
|  | flags |= SEC_READONLY; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case noload_section: | 
|  | flags &= ~SEC_LOAD; | 
|  | flags |= SEC_NEVER_LOAD; | 
|  | /* Unfortunately GNU ld has managed to evolve two different | 
|  | meanings to NOLOAD in scripts.  ELF gets a .bss style noload, | 
|  | alloc, no contents section.  All others get a noload, noalloc | 
|  | section.  */ | 
|  | if (bfd_get_flavour (link_info.output_bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour) | 
|  | flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS; | 
|  | else | 
|  | flags &= ~SEC_ALLOC; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (output->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | init_os (output, flags); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If SEC_READONLY is not set in the input section, then clear | 
|  | it from the output section.  */ | 
|  | output->bfd_section->flags &= flags | ~SEC_READONLY; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (output->bfd_section->linker_has_input) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Only set SEC_READONLY flag on the first input section.  */ | 
|  | flags &= ~ SEC_READONLY; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Keep SEC_MERGE and SEC_STRINGS only if they are the same.  */ | 
|  | if ((output->bfd_section->flags & (SEC_MERGE | SEC_STRINGS)) | 
|  | != (flags & (SEC_MERGE | SEC_STRINGS)) | 
|  | || ((flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0 | 
|  | && output->bfd_section->entsize != section->entsize)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | output->bfd_section->flags &= ~ (SEC_MERGE | SEC_STRINGS); | 
|  | flags &= ~ (SEC_MERGE | SEC_STRINGS); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | output->bfd_section->flags |= flags; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!output->bfd_section->linker_has_input) | 
|  | { | 
|  | output->bfd_section->linker_has_input = 1; | 
|  | /* This must happen after flags have been updated.  The output | 
|  | section may have been created before we saw its first input | 
|  | section, eg. for a data statement.  */ | 
|  | bfd_init_private_section_data (section->owner, section, | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | output->bfd_section, | 
|  | &link_info); | 
|  | if ((flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0) | 
|  | output->bfd_section->entsize = section->entsize; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((flags & SEC_TIC54X_BLOCK) != 0 | 
|  | && bfd_get_arch (section->owner) == bfd_arch_tic54x) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* FIXME: This value should really be obtained from the bfd...  */ | 
|  | output->block_value = 128; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* When a .ctors section is placed in .init_array it must be copied | 
|  | in reverse order.  Similarly for .dtors.  Set that up.  */ | 
|  | if (bfd_get_flavour (link_info.output_bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour | 
|  | && ((startswith (section->name, ".ctors") | 
|  | && strcmp (output->bfd_section->name, ".init_array") == 0) | 
|  | || (startswith (section->name, ".dtors") | 
|  | && strcmp (output->bfd_section->name, ".fini_array") == 0)) | 
|  | && (section->name[6] == 0 || section->name[6] == '.')) | 
|  | section->flags |= SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (section->alignment_power > output->bfd_section->alignment_power) | 
|  | output->bfd_section->alignment_power = section->alignment_power; | 
|  |  | 
|  | section->output_section = output->bfd_section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!map_head_is_link_order) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *s = output->bfd_section->map_tail.s; | 
|  | output->bfd_section->map_tail.s = section; | 
|  | section->map_head.s = NULL; | 
|  | section->map_tail.s = s; | 
|  | if (s != NULL) | 
|  | s->map_head.s = section; | 
|  | else | 
|  | output->bfd_section->map_head.s = section; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add a section reference to the list.  */ | 
|  | new_section = new_stat (lang_input_section, ptr); | 
|  | new_section->section = section; | 
|  | new_section->pattern = pattern; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Expand a wild statement for a particular FILE.  SECTION may be | 
|  | NULL, in which case it is a wild card.  This assumes that the | 
|  | wild statement doesn't need any sorting (of filenames or sections).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | output_section_callback_nosort (lang_wild_statement_type *ptr, | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | asection *section, | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | void *output) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os = (lang_output_section_statement_type *) output; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Exclude sections that match UNIQUE_SECTION_LIST.  */ | 
|  | if (unique_section_p (section, os)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_add_section (&ptr->children, section, ptr->section_list, | 
|  | ptr->section_flag_list, os); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check if all sections in a wild statement for a particular FILE | 
|  | are readonly.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | check_section_callback (lang_wild_statement_type *ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | asection *section, | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | void *output) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os = (lang_output_section_statement_type *) output; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Exclude sections that match UNIQUE_SECTION_LIST.  */ | 
|  | if (unique_section_p (section, os)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (section->output_section == NULL && (section->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0) | 
|  | os->all_input_readonly = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is passed a file name which must have been seen already and | 
|  | added to the statement tree.  We will see if it has been opened | 
|  | already and had its symbols read.  If not then we'll read it.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_input_statement_type * | 
|  | lookup_name (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *search; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (search = (void *) input_file_chain.head; | 
|  | search != NULL; | 
|  | search = search->next_real_file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Use the local_sym_name as the name of the file that has | 
|  | already been loaded as filename might have been transformed | 
|  | via the search directory lookup mechanism.  */ | 
|  | const char *filename = search->local_sym_name; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (filename != NULL | 
|  | && filename_cmp (filename, name) == 0) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (search == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Arrange to splice the input statement added by new_afile into | 
|  | statement_list after the current input_file_chain tail. | 
|  | We know input_file_chain is not an empty list, and that | 
|  | lookup_name was called via open_input_bfds.  Later calls to | 
|  | lookup_name should always match an existing input_statement.  */ | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **tail = stat_ptr->tail; | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **after | 
|  | = (void *) ((char *) input_file_chain.tail | 
|  | - offsetof (lang_input_statement_type, next_real_file) | 
|  | + offsetof (lang_input_statement_type, header.next)); | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type *rest = *after; | 
|  | stat_ptr->tail = after; | 
|  | search = new_afile (name, lang_input_file_is_search_file_enum, | 
|  | default_target, NULL); | 
|  | *stat_ptr->tail = rest; | 
|  | if (*tail == NULL) | 
|  | stat_ptr->tail = tail; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have already added this file, or this file is not real | 
|  | don't add this file.  */ | 
|  | if (search->flags.loaded || !search->flags.real) | 
|  | return search; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!load_symbols (search, NULL)) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return search; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Save LIST as a list of libraries whose symbols should not be exported.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct excluded_lib | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *name; | 
|  | struct excluded_lib *next; | 
|  | }; | 
|  | static struct excluded_lib *excluded_libs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | add_excluded_libs (const char *list) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *p = list, *end; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (*p != '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct excluded_lib *entry; | 
|  | end = strpbrk (p, ",:"); | 
|  | if (end == NULL) | 
|  | end = p + strlen (p); | 
|  | entry = stat_alloc (sizeof (*entry)); | 
|  | entry->next = excluded_libs; | 
|  | entry->name = stat_memdup (p, end - p, end - p + 1); | 
|  | excluded_libs = entry; | 
|  | if (*end == '\0') | 
|  | break; | 
|  | p = end + 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | check_excluded_libs (bfd *abfd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct excluded_lib *lib = excluded_libs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (lib) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int len = strlen (lib->name); | 
|  | const char *filename = lbasename (bfd_get_filename (abfd)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (strcmp (lib->name, "ALL") == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | abfd->no_export = true; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (filename_ncmp (lib->name, filename, len) == 0 | 
|  | && (filename[len] == '\0' | 
|  | || (filename[len] == '.' && filename[len + 1] == 'a' | 
|  | && filename[len + 2] == '\0'))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | abfd->no_export = true; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lib = lib->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Get the symbols for an input file.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool | 
|  | load_symbols (lang_input_statement_type *entry, | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type *place) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char **matching; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (entry->flags.loaded) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldfile_open_file (entry); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do not process further if the file was missing.  */ | 
|  | if (entry->flags.missing_file) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (trace_files || verbose) | 
|  | info_msg ("%pI\n", entry); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_check_format (entry->the_bfd, bfd_archive) | 
|  | && !bfd_check_format_matches (entry->the_bfd, bfd_object, &matching)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_error_type err; | 
|  | struct lang_input_statement_flags save_flags; | 
|  | extern FILE *yyin; | 
|  |  | 
|  | err = bfd_get_error (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See if the emulation has some special knowledge.  */ | 
|  | if (ldemul_unrecognized_file (entry)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (err == bfd_error_file_ambiguously_recognized) | 
|  | free (matching); | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (err == bfd_error_file_ambiguously_recognized) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char **p; | 
|  |  | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: %pB: file not recognized: %E;" | 
|  | " matching formats:"), entry->the_bfd); | 
|  | for (p = matching; *p != NULL; p++) | 
|  | einfo (" %s", *p); | 
|  | free (matching); | 
|  | fatal ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (err != bfd_error_file_not_recognized | 
|  | || place == NULL) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: %pB: file not recognized: %E\n"), entry->the_bfd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bfd_close (entry->the_bfd); | 
|  | entry->the_bfd = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Try to interpret the file as a linker script.  */ | 
|  | save_flags = input_flags; | 
|  | ldfile_open_command_file (entry->filename); | 
|  |  | 
|  | push_stat_ptr (place); | 
|  | input_flags.add_DT_NEEDED_for_regular | 
|  | = entry->flags.add_DT_NEEDED_for_regular; | 
|  | input_flags.add_DT_NEEDED_for_dynamic | 
|  | = entry->flags.add_DT_NEEDED_for_dynamic; | 
|  | input_flags.whole_archive = entry->flags.whole_archive; | 
|  | input_flags.dynamic = entry->flags.dynamic; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldfile_assumed_script = true; | 
|  | parser_input = input_script; | 
|  | current_input_file = entry->filename; | 
|  | yyparse (); | 
|  | current_input_file = NULL; | 
|  | ldfile_assumed_script = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* missing_file is sticky.  sysrooted will already have been | 
|  | restored when seeing EOF in yyparse, but no harm to restore | 
|  | again.  */ | 
|  | save_flags.missing_file |= input_flags.missing_file; | 
|  | input_flags = save_flags; | 
|  | pop_stat_ptr (); | 
|  | fclose (yyin); | 
|  | yyin = NULL; | 
|  | entry->flags.loaded = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ldemul_recognized_file (entry)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We don't call ldlang_add_file for an archive.  Instead, the | 
|  | add_symbols entry point will call ldlang_add_file, via the | 
|  | add_archive_element callback, for each element of the archive | 
|  | which is used.  */ | 
|  | switch (bfd_get_format (entry->the_bfd)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bfd_object: | 
|  | if (!entry->flags.reload) | 
|  | ldlang_add_file (entry); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case bfd_archive: | 
|  | check_excluded_libs (entry->the_bfd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bfd_set_usrdata (entry->the_bfd, entry); | 
|  | if (entry->flags.whole_archive) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd *member = NULL; | 
|  | bool loaded = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (;;) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd *subsbfd; | 
|  | member = bfd_openr_next_archived_file (entry->the_bfd, member); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (member == NULL) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_check_format (member, bfd_object)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: %pB: member %pB in archive is not an object\n"), | 
|  | entry->the_bfd, member); | 
|  | loaded = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.emitting_gnu_object_only) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!cmdline_on_object_only_archive_list_p (member)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | subsbfd = member; | 
|  | if (!(*link_info.callbacks | 
|  | ->add_archive_element) (&link_info, member, | 
|  | "--whole-archive", &subsbfd)) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Potentially, the add_archive_element hook may have set a | 
|  | substitute BFD for us.  */ | 
|  | if (!bfd_link_add_symbols (subsbfd, &link_info)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: %pB: error adding symbols: %E\n"), member); | 
|  | loaded = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | entry->flags.loaded = loaded; | 
|  | return loaded; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bfd_link_add_symbols (entry->the_bfd, &link_info)) | 
|  | entry->flags.loaded = true; | 
|  | else | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: %pB: error adding symbols: %E\n"), entry->the_bfd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return entry->flags.loaded; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Handle a wild statement.  S->FILENAME or S->SECTION_LIST or both | 
|  | may be NULL, indicating that it is a wildcard.  Separate | 
|  | lang_input_section statements are created for each part of the | 
|  | expansion; they are added after the wild statement S.  OUTPUT is | 
|  | the output section.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | wild (lang_wild_statement_type *s, | 
|  | const char *target ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *output) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (s->filenames_sorted || s->any_specs_sorted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_section_bst_type *tree; | 
|  |  | 
|  | walk_wild (s, output_section_callback_sort, output); | 
|  |  | 
|  | tree = s->tree; | 
|  | if (tree) | 
|  | { | 
|  | output_section_callback_tree_to_list (s, tree, output); | 
|  | s->tree = NULL; | 
|  | s->rightmost = &s->tree; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | walk_wild (s, output_section_callback_nosort, output); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (default_common_section == NULL) | 
|  | for (sec = s->section_list; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next) | 
|  | if (sec->spec.name != NULL && strcmp (sec->spec.name, "COMMON") == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Remember the section that common is going to in case we | 
|  | later get something which doesn't know where to put it.  */ | 
|  | default_common_section = output; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return TRUE iff target is the sought target.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | get_target (const bfd_target *target, void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *sought = (const char *) data; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return strcmp (target->name, sought) == 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Like strcpy() but convert to lower case as well.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | stricpy (char *dest, const char *src) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char c; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while ((c = *src++) != 0) | 
|  | *dest++ = TOLOWER (c); | 
|  |  | 
|  | *dest = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove the first occurrence of needle (if any) in haystack | 
|  | from haystack.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | strcut (char *haystack, const char *needle) | 
|  | { | 
|  | haystack = strstr (haystack, needle); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (haystack) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *src; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (src = haystack + strlen (needle); *src;) | 
|  | *haystack++ = *src++; | 
|  |  | 
|  | *haystack = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Compare two target format name strings. | 
|  | Return a value indicating how "similar" they are.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | name_compare (const char *first, const char *second) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *copy1; | 
|  | char *copy2; | 
|  | int result; | 
|  |  | 
|  | copy1 = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (first) + 1); | 
|  | copy2 = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (second) + 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Convert the names to lower case.  */ | 
|  | stricpy (copy1, first); | 
|  | stricpy (copy2, second); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove size and endian strings from the name.  */ | 
|  | strcut (copy1, "big"); | 
|  | strcut (copy1, "little"); | 
|  | strcut (copy2, "big"); | 
|  | strcut (copy2, "little"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return a value based on how many characters match, | 
|  | starting from the beginning.   If both strings are | 
|  | the same then return 10 * their length.  */ | 
|  | for (result = 0; copy1[result] == copy2[result]; result++) | 
|  | if (copy1[result] == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | result *= 10; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | free (copy1); | 
|  | free (copy2); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set by closest_target_match() below.  */ | 
|  | static const bfd_target *winner; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Scan all the valid bfd targets looking for one that has the endianness | 
|  | requirement that was specified on the command line, and is the nearest | 
|  | match to the original output target.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | closest_target_match (const bfd_target *target, void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const bfd_target *original = (const bfd_target *) data; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (command_line.endian == ENDIAN_BIG | 
|  | && target->byteorder != BFD_ENDIAN_BIG) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (command_line.endian == ENDIAN_LITTLE | 
|  | && target->byteorder != BFD_ENDIAN_LITTLE) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Must be the same flavour.  */ | 
|  | if (target->flavour != original->flavour) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Ignore generic big and little endian elf vectors.  */ | 
|  | if (strcmp (target->name, "elf32-big") == 0 | 
|  | || strcmp (target->name, "elf64-big") == 0 | 
|  | || strcmp (target->name, "elf32-little") == 0 | 
|  | || strcmp (target->name, "elf64-little") == 0) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have not found a potential winner yet, then record this one.  */ | 
|  | if (winner == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | winner = target; | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Oh dear, we now have two potential candidates for a successful match. | 
|  | Compare their names and choose the better one.  */ | 
|  | if (name_compare (target->name, original->name) | 
|  | > name_compare (winner->name, original->name)) | 
|  | winner = target; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Keep on searching until wqe have checked them all.  */ | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return the BFD target format of the first input file.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char * | 
|  | get_first_input_target (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *target = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (s->header.type == lang_input_statement_enum | 
|  | && s->flags.real) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ldfile_open_file (s); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (s->the_bfd != NULL | 
|  | && bfd_check_format (s->the_bfd, bfd_object)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | target = bfd_get_target (s->the_bfd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (target != NULL) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return target; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | const char * | 
|  | lang_get_output_target (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *target; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Has the user told us which output format to use?  */ | 
|  | if (output_target != NULL) | 
|  | return output_target; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* No - has the current target been set to something other than | 
|  | the default?  */ | 
|  | if (current_target != default_target && current_target != NULL) | 
|  | return current_target; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* No - can we determine the format of the first input file?  */ | 
|  | target = get_first_input_target (); | 
|  | if (target != NULL) | 
|  | return target; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Failed - use the default output target.  */ | 
|  | return default_target; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Open the output file.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | open_output (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *f; | 
|  | char *out = lrealpath (name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (f = (void *) input_file_chain.head; | 
|  | f != NULL; | 
|  | f = f->next_real_file) | 
|  | if (f->flags.real) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *in = lrealpath (f->local_sym_name); | 
|  | if (filename_cmp (in, out) == 0) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: input file '%s' is the same as output file\n"), | 
|  | f->filename); | 
|  | free (in); | 
|  | } | 
|  | free (out); | 
|  |  | 
|  | output_target = lang_get_output_target (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Has the user requested a particular endianness on the command | 
|  | line?  */ | 
|  | if (command_line.endian != ENDIAN_UNSET) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Get the chosen target.  */ | 
|  | const bfd_target *target | 
|  | = bfd_iterate_over_targets (get_target, (void *) output_target); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If the target is not supported, we cannot do anything.  */ | 
|  | if (target != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | enum bfd_endian desired_endian; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (command_line.endian == ENDIAN_BIG) | 
|  | desired_endian = BFD_ENDIAN_BIG; | 
|  | else | 
|  | desired_endian = BFD_ENDIAN_LITTLE; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See if the target has the wrong endianness.  This should | 
|  | not happen if the linker script has provided big and | 
|  | little endian alternatives, but some scrips don't do | 
|  | this.  */ | 
|  | if (target->byteorder != desired_endian) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If it does, then see if the target provides | 
|  | an alternative with the correct endianness.  */ | 
|  | if (target->alternative_target != NULL | 
|  | && (target->alternative_target->byteorder == desired_endian)) | 
|  | output_target = target->alternative_target->name; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Try to find a target as similar as possible to | 
|  | the default target, but which has the desired | 
|  | endian characteristic.  */ | 
|  | bfd_iterate_over_targets (closest_target_match, | 
|  | (void *) target); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Oh dear - we could not find any targets that | 
|  | satisfy our requirements.  */ | 
|  | if (winner == NULL) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: could not find any targets" | 
|  | " that match endianness requirement\n")); | 
|  | else | 
|  | output_target = winner->name; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd = bfd_openw (name, output_target); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.output_bfd == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (bfd_get_error () == bfd_error_invalid_target) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: target %s not found\n"), output_target); | 
|  |  | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: cannot open output file %s: %E\n"), name); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | delete_output_file_on_failure = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_set_format (link_info.output_bfd, bfd_object)) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: %s: can not make object file: %E\n"), name); | 
|  | if (!bfd_set_arch_mach (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | ldfile_output_architecture, | 
|  | ldfile_output_machine)) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: %s: can not set architecture: %E\n"), name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | link_info.hash = bfd_link_hash_table_create (link_info.output_bfd); | 
|  | if (link_info.hash == NULL) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: can not create hash table: %E\n")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bfd_set_gp_size (link_info.output_bfd, g_switch_value); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | ldlang_open_output (lang_statement_union_type *statement) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (statement->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_output_statement_enum: | 
|  | ASSERT (link_info.output_bfd == NULL); | 
|  | open_output (statement->output_statement.name); | 
|  | ldemul_set_output_arch (); | 
|  | if (config.magic_demand_paged | 
|  | && !bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->flags |= D_PAGED; | 
|  | else | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->flags &= ~D_PAGED; | 
|  | if (config.text_read_only) | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->flags |= WP_TEXT; | 
|  | else | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->flags &= ~WP_TEXT; | 
|  | if (link_info.traditional_format) | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->flags |= BFD_TRADITIONAL_FORMAT; | 
|  | else | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->flags &= ~BFD_TRADITIONAL_FORMAT; | 
|  | if (config.no_section_header) | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->flags |= BFD_NO_SECTION_HEADER; | 
|  | else | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->flags &= ~BFD_NO_SECTION_HEADER; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_target_statement_enum: | 
|  | current_target = statement->target_statement.target; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | init_opb (asection *s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | unsigned int x; | 
|  |  | 
|  | opb_shift = 0; | 
|  | if (bfd_get_flavour (link_info.output_bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour | 
|  | && s != NULL | 
|  | && (s->flags & SEC_ELF_OCTETS) != 0) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | x = bfd_arch_mach_octets_per_byte (ldfile_output_architecture, | 
|  | ldfile_output_machine); | 
|  | if (x > 1) | 
|  | while ((x & 1) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | x >>= 1; | 
|  | ++opb_shift; | 
|  | } | 
|  | ASSERT (x == 1); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Open all the input files.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum open_bfd_mode | 
|  | { | 
|  | OPEN_BFD_NORMAL = 0, | 
|  | OPEN_BFD_FORCE = 1, | 
|  | OPEN_BFD_RESCAN = 2 | 
|  | }; | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | static lang_input_statement_type *plugin_insert = NULL; | 
|  | static struct bfd_link_hash_entry *plugin_undefs = NULL; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | open_input_bfds (lang_statement_union_type *s, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os, | 
|  | enum open_bfd_mode mode) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; s != NULL; s = s->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (s->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | open_input_bfds (constructor_list.head, os, mode); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | os = &s->output_section_statement; | 
|  | open_input_bfds (os->children.head, os, mode); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | /* Maybe we should load the file's symbols.  */ | 
|  | if ((mode & OPEN_BFD_RESCAN) == 0 | 
|  | && s->wild_statement.filename | 
|  | && !wildcardp (s->wild_statement.filename) | 
|  | && !archive_path (s->wild_statement.filename)) | 
|  | lookup_name (s->wild_statement.filename); | 
|  | open_input_bfds (s->wild_statement.children.head, os, mode); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_link_hash_entry *undefs; | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *plugin_insert_save; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We must continually search the entries in the group | 
|  | until no new symbols are added to the list of undefined | 
|  | symbols.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | do | 
|  | { | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | plugin_insert_save = plugin_insert; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | undefs = link_info.hash->undefs_tail; | 
|  | open_input_bfds (s->group_statement.children.head, os, | 
|  | mode | OPEN_BFD_FORCE); | 
|  | } | 
|  | while (undefs != link_info.hash->undefs_tail | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | /* Objects inserted by a plugin, which are loaded | 
|  | before we hit this loop, may have added new | 
|  | undefs.  */ | 
|  | || (plugin_insert != plugin_insert_save && plugin_undefs) | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | ); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_target_statement_enum: | 
|  | current_target = s->target_statement.target; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_statement_enum: | 
|  | if (s->input_statement.flags.real) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **os_tail; | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type add; | 
|  | bfd *abfd; | 
|  |  | 
|  | s->input_statement.target = current_target; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we are being called from within a group, and this | 
|  | is an archive which has already been searched, then | 
|  | force it to be researched unless the whole archive | 
|  | has been loaded already.  Do the same for a rescan. | 
|  | Likewise reload --as-needed shared libs.  */ | 
|  | if (mode != OPEN_BFD_NORMAL | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | && ((mode & OPEN_BFD_RESCAN) == 0 | 
|  | || plugin_insert == NULL) | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | && s->input_statement.flags.loaded | 
|  | && (abfd = s->input_statement.the_bfd) != NULL | 
|  | && ((bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_archive | 
|  | && !s->input_statement.flags.whole_archive) | 
|  | || (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object | 
|  | && ((abfd->flags) & DYNAMIC) != 0 | 
|  | && s->input_statement.flags.add_DT_NEEDED_for_regular | 
|  | && bfd_get_flavour (abfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour | 
|  | && (elf_dyn_lib_class (abfd) & DYN_AS_NEEDED) != 0))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | s->input_statement.flags.loaded = false; | 
|  | s->input_statement.flags.reload = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | os_tail = lang_os_list.tail; | 
|  | lang_list_init (&add); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!load_symbols (&s->input_statement, &add)) | 
|  | config.make_executable = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (add.head != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If this was a script with output sections then | 
|  | tack any added statements on to the end of the | 
|  | list.  This avoids having to reorder the output | 
|  | section statement list.  Very likely the user | 
|  | forgot -T, and whatever we do here will not meet | 
|  | naive user expectations.  */ | 
|  | if (os_tail != lang_os_list.tail) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: %s contains output sections;" | 
|  | " did you forget -T?\n"), | 
|  | s->input_statement.filename); | 
|  | *stat_ptr->tail = add.head; | 
|  | stat_ptr->tail = add.tail; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | *add.tail = s->header.next; | 
|  | s->header.next = add.head; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | /* If we have found the point at which a plugin added new | 
|  | files, clear plugin_insert to enable archive rescan.  */ | 
|  | if (&s->input_statement == plugin_insert) | 
|  | plugin_insert = NULL; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_assignment_statement_enum: | 
|  | if (s->assignment_statement.exp->type.node_class != etree_assert) | 
|  | exp_fold_tree_no_dot (s->assignment_statement.exp, os); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Exit if any of the files were missing.  */ | 
|  | if (input_flags.missing_file) | 
|  | fatal (""); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef ENABLE_LIBCTF | 
|  | /* Emit CTF errors and warnings.  fp can be NULL to report errors/warnings | 
|  | that happened specifically at CTF open time.  */ | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_ctf_errs_warnings (ctf_dict_t *fp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ctf_next_t *i = NULL; | 
|  | char *text; | 
|  | int is_warning; | 
|  | int err; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while ((text = ctf_errwarning_next (fp, &i, &is_warning, &err)) != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("%s: %s\n"), is_warning ? _("CTF warning"): _("CTF error"), | 
|  | text); | 
|  | free (text); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (err != ECTF_NEXT_END) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("CTF error: cannot get CTF errors: `%s'\n"), | 
|  | ctf_errmsg (err)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* `err' returns errors from the error/warning iterator in particular. | 
|  | These never assert.  But if we have an fp, that could have recorded | 
|  | an assertion failure: assert if it has done so.  */ | 
|  | ASSERT (!fp || ctf_errno (fp) != ECTF_INTERNAL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Open the CTF sections in the input files with libctf: if any were opened, | 
|  | create a fake input file that we'll write the merged CTF data to later | 
|  | on.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | ldlang_open_ctf (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int any_ctf = 0; | 
|  | int err; | 
|  |  | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *sect; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Incoming files from the compiler have a single ctf_dict_t in them | 
|  | (which is presented to us by the libctf API in a ctf_archive_t | 
|  | wrapper): files derived from a previous relocatable link have a CTF | 
|  | archive containing possibly many CTF files.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((file->the_ctf = ctf_bfdopen (file->the_bfd, &err)) == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (err != ECTF_NOCTFDATA) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_ctf_errs_warnings (NULL); | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: CTF section in %pB not loaded; " | 
|  | "its types will be discarded: %s\n"), file->the_bfd, | 
|  | ctf_errmsg (err)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Prevent the contents of this section from being written, while | 
|  | requiring the section itself to be duplicated in the output, but only | 
|  | once.  */ | 
|  | /* This section must exist if ctf_bfdopen() succeeded.  */ | 
|  | sect = bfd_get_section_by_name (file->the_bfd, ".ctf"); | 
|  | sect->size = 0; | 
|  | sect->flags |= SEC_NEVER_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LINKER_CREATED; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (any_ctf) | 
|  | sect->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; | 
|  | any_ctf = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!any_ctf) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ctf_output = NULL; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((ctf_output = ctf_create (&err)) != NULL) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: CTF output not created: `%s'\n"), | 
|  | ctf_errmsg (err)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (errfile) | 
|  | ctf_close (errfile->the_ctf); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Merge together CTF sections.  After this, only the symtab-dependent | 
|  | function and data object sections need adjustment.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_merge_ctf (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *output_sect; | 
|  | int flags = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!ctf_output) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | output_sect = bfd_get_section_by_name (link_info.output_bfd, ".ctf"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If the section was discarded, don't waste time merging.  */ | 
|  | if (output_sect == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ctf_dict_close (ctf_output); | 
|  | ctf_output = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ctf_close (file->the_ctf); | 
|  | file->the_ctf = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!file->the_ctf) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Takes ownership of file->the_ctf.  */ | 
|  | if (ctf_link_add_ctf (ctf_output, file->the_ctf, file->filename) < 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: CTF section in %pB cannot be linked: `%s'\n"), | 
|  | file->the_bfd, ctf_errmsg (ctf_errno (ctf_output))); | 
|  | ctf_close (file->the_ctf); | 
|  | file->the_ctf = NULL; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!config.ctf_share_duplicated) | 
|  | flags = CTF_LINK_SHARE_UNCONFLICTED; | 
|  | else | 
|  | flags = CTF_LINK_SHARE_DUPLICATED; | 
|  | if (!config.ctf_variables) | 
|  | flags |= CTF_LINK_OMIT_VARIABLES_SECTION; | 
|  | if (bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | flags |= CTF_LINK_NO_FILTER_REPORTED_SYMS; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ctf_link (ctf_output, flags) < 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_ctf_errs_warnings (ctf_output); | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: CTF linking failed; " | 
|  | "output will have no CTF section: %s\n"), | 
|  | ctf_errmsg (ctf_errno (ctf_output))); | 
|  | if (output_sect) | 
|  | { | 
|  | output_sect->size = 0; | 
|  | output_sect->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Output any lingering errors that didn't come from ctf_link.  */ | 
|  | lang_ctf_errs_warnings (ctf_output); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Let the emulation acquire strings from the dynamic strtab to help it optimize | 
|  | the CTF, if supported.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | ldlang_ctf_acquire_strings (struct elf_strtab_hash *dynstrtab) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ldemul_acquire_strings_for_ctf (ctf_output, dynstrtab); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Inform the emulation about the addition of a new dynamic symbol, in BFD | 
|  | internal format.  */ | 
|  | void ldlang_ctf_new_dynsym (int symidx, struct elf_internal_sym *sym) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ldemul_new_dynsym_for_ctf (ctf_output, symidx, sym); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Write out the CTF section.  Called early, if the emulation isn't going to | 
|  | need to dedup against the strtab and symtab, then possibly called from the | 
|  | target linker code if the dedup has happened.  */ | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_write_ctf (int late) | 
|  | { | 
|  | size_t output_size; | 
|  | asection *output_sect; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!ctf_output) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (late) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Emit CTF late if this emulation says it can do so.  */ | 
|  | if (ldemul_emit_ctf_early ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!ldemul_emit_ctf_early ()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Inform the emulation that all the symbols that will be received have | 
|  | been.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_new_dynsym_for_ctf (ctf_output, 0, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Emit CTF.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | output_sect = bfd_get_section_by_name (link_info.output_bfd, ".ctf"); | 
|  | if (output_sect) | 
|  | { | 
|  | output_sect->contents = ctf_link_write (ctf_output, &output_size, | 
|  | CTF_COMPRESSION_THRESHOLD); | 
|  | output_sect->size = output_size; | 
|  | output_sect->flags |= SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_KEEP; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_ctf_errs_warnings (ctf_output); | 
|  | if (!output_sect->contents) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: CTF section emission failed; " | 
|  | "output will have no CTF section: %s\n"), | 
|  | ctf_errmsg (ctf_errno (ctf_output))); | 
|  | output_sect->size = 0; | 
|  | output_sect->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This also closes every CTF input file used in the link.  */ | 
|  | ctf_dict_close (ctf_output); | 
|  | ctf_output = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (file) | 
|  | file->the_ctf = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Write out the CTF section late, if the emulation needs that.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | ldlang_write_ctf_late (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Trigger a "late call", if the emulation needs one.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_write_ctf (1); | 
|  | } | 
|  | #else | 
|  | static void | 
|  | ldlang_open_ctf (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *sect; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If built without CTF, warn and delete all CTF sections from the output. | 
|  | (The alternative would be to simply concatenate them, which does not | 
|  | yield a valid CTF section.)  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((sect = bfd_get_section_by_name (file->the_bfd, ".ctf")) != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: CTF section in %pB not linkable: " | 
|  | "%P was built without support for CTF\n"), file->the_bfd); | 
|  | sect->size = 0; | 
|  | sect->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void lang_merge_ctf (void) {} | 
|  | void | 
|  | ldlang_ctf_acquire_strings (struct elf_strtab_hash *dynstrtab | 
|  | ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) {} | 
|  | void | 
|  | ldlang_ctf_new_dynsym (int symidx ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | struct elf_internal_sym *sym ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) {} | 
|  | static void lang_write_ctf (int late ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) {} | 
|  | void ldlang_write_ctf_late (void) {} | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add the supplied name to the symbol table as an undefined reference. | 
|  | This is a two step process as the symbol table doesn't even exist at | 
|  | the time the ld command line is processed.  First we put the name | 
|  | on a list, then, once the output file has been opened, transfer the | 
|  | name to the symbol table.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | typedef struct bfd_sym_chain ldlang_undef_chain_list_type; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define ldlang_undef_chain_list_head entry_symbol.next | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | ldlang_add_undef (const char *const name, bool cmdline ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ldlang_undef_chain_list_type *new_undef; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_undef = stat_alloc (sizeof (*new_undef)); | 
|  | new_undef->next = ldlang_undef_chain_list_head; | 
|  | ldlang_undef_chain_list_head = new_undef; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_undef->name = stat_strdup (name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.output_bfd != NULL) | 
|  | insert_undefined (new_undef->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Insert NAME as undefined in the symbol table.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | insert_undefined (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h; | 
|  |  | 
|  | h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (link_info.hash, name, true, false, true); | 
|  | if (h == NULL) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: bfd_link_hash_lookup failed: %E\n")); | 
|  | if (h->type == bfd_link_hash_new) | 
|  | { | 
|  | h->type = bfd_link_hash_undefined; | 
|  | h->u.undef.abfd = NULL; | 
|  | h->non_ir_ref_regular = true; | 
|  | bfd_link_add_undef (link_info.hash, h); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Run through the list of undefineds created above and place them | 
|  | into the linker hash table as undefined symbols belonging to the | 
|  | script file.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_place_undefineds (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ldlang_undef_chain_list_type *ptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ptr = ldlang_undef_chain_list_head; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->next) | 
|  | insert_undefined (ptr->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Mark -u symbols against garbage collection.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_mark_undefineds (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ldlang_undef_chain_list_type *ptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (is_elf_hash_table (link_info.hash)) | 
|  | for (ptr = ldlang_undef_chain_list_head; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) | 
|  | bfd_link_hash_lookup (link_info.hash, ptr->name, false, false, true); | 
|  | if (h != NULL) | 
|  | h->mark = 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Structure used to build the list of symbols that the user has required | 
|  | be defined.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct require_defined_symbol | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *name; | 
|  | struct require_defined_symbol *next; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The list of symbols that the user has required be defined.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct require_defined_symbol *require_defined_symbol_list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add a new symbol NAME to the list of symbols that are required to be | 
|  | defined.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | ldlang_add_require_defined (const char *const name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct require_defined_symbol *ptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldlang_add_undef (name, true); | 
|  | ptr = stat_alloc (sizeof (*ptr)); | 
|  | ptr->next = require_defined_symbol_list; | 
|  | ptr->name = stat_strdup (name); | 
|  | require_defined_symbol_list = ptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check that all symbols the user required to be defined, are defined, | 
|  | raise an error if we find a symbol that is not defined.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | ldlang_check_require_defined_symbols (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct require_defined_symbol *ptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ptr = require_defined_symbol_list; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h; | 
|  |  | 
|  | h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (link_info.hash, ptr->name, | 
|  | false, false, true); | 
|  | if (h == NULL | 
|  | || (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined | 
|  | && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)) | 
|  | einfo(_("%X%P: required symbol `%s' not defined\n"), ptr->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check for all readonly or some readwrite sections.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | check_input_sections | 
|  | (lang_statement_union_type *s, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *output_section_statement) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; s != NULL; s = s->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (s->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | walk_wild (&s->wild_statement, check_section_callback, | 
|  | output_section_statement); | 
|  | if (!output_section_statement->all_input_readonly) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | check_input_sections (constructor_list.head, | 
|  | output_section_statement); | 
|  | if (!output_section_statement->all_input_readonly) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | check_input_sections (s->group_statement.children.head, | 
|  | output_section_statement); | 
|  | if (!output_section_statement->all_input_readonly) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update wildcard statements if needed.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | update_wild_statements (lang_statement_union_type *s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (sort_section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | FAIL (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case none: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_name: | 
|  | case by_alignment: | 
|  | for (; s != NULL; s = s->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (s->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | for (sec = s->wild_statement.section_list; sec != NULL; | 
|  | sec = sec->next) | 
|  | /* Don't sort .init/.fini sections.  */ | 
|  | if (strcmp (sec->spec.name, ".init") != 0 | 
|  | && strcmp (sec->spec.name, ".fini") != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (sec->spec.sorted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case none: | 
|  | sec->spec.sorted = sort_section; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case by_name: | 
|  | if (sort_section == by_alignment) | 
|  | sec->spec.sorted = by_name_alignment; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case by_alignment: | 
|  | if (sort_section == by_name) | 
|  | sec->spec.sorted = by_alignment_name; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | s->wild_statement.any_specs_sorted = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | update_wild_statements (constructor_list.head); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | update_wild_statements | 
|  | (s->output_section_statement.children.head); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | update_wild_statements (s->group_statement.children.head); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Open input files and attach to output sections.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | map_input_to_output_sections | 
|  | (lang_statement_union_type *s, const char *target, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; s != NULL; s = s->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *tos; | 
|  | flagword flags; | 
|  | unsigned int type = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (s->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | wild (&s->wild_statement, target, os); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | map_input_to_output_sections (constructor_list.head, | 
|  | target, | 
|  | os); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | tos = &s->output_section_statement; | 
|  | if (tos->constraint == ONLY_IF_RW | 
|  | || tos->constraint == ONLY_IF_RO) | 
|  | { | 
|  | tos->all_input_readonly = true; | 
|  | check_input_sections (tos->children.head, tos); | 
|  | if (tos->all_input_readonly != (tos->constraint == ONLY_IF_RO)) | 
|  | tos->constraint = -1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (tos->constraint >= 0) | 
|  | map_input_to_output_sections (tos->children.head, | 
|  | target, | 
|  | tos); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_output_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_target_statement_enum: | 
|  | target = s->target_statement.target; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | map_input_to_output_sections (s->group_statement.children.head, | 
|  | target, | 
|  | os); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_data_statement_enum: | 
|  | if (os == NULL) | 
|  | /* This should never happen.  */ | 
|  | FAIL (); | 
|  | /* Make sure that any sections mentioned in the expression | 
|  | are initialized.  */ | 
|  | exp_init_os (s->data_statement.exp); | 
|  | /* The output section gets CONTENTS, ALLOC and LOAD, but | 
|  | these may be overridden by the script.  */ | 
|  | flags = SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD; | 
|  | switch (os->sectype) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case normal_section: | 
|  | case overlay_section: | 
|  | case first_overlay_section: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case noalloc_section: | 
|  | flags = SEC_HAS_CONTENTS; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case readonly_section: | 
|  | flags |= SEC_READONLY; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case typed_readonly_section: | 
|  | flags |= SEC_READONLY; | 
|  | /* Fall through.  */ | 
|  | case type_section: | 
|  | if (os->sectype_value->type.node_class == etree_name | 
|  | && os->sectype_value->type.node_code == NAME) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *name = os->sectype_value->name.name; | 
|  | if (strcmp (name, "SHT_PROGBITS") == 0) | 
|  | type = SHT_PROGBITS; | 
|  | else if (strcmp (name, "SHT_STRTAB") == 0) | 
|  | type = SHT_STRTAB; | 
|  | else if (strcmp (name, "SHT_NOTE") == 0) | 
|  | type = SHT_NOTE; | 
|  | else if (strcmp (name, "SHT_NOBITS") == 0) | 
|  | type = SHT_NOBITS; | 
|  | else if (strcmp (name, "SHT_INIT_ARRAY") == 0) | 
|  | type = SHT_INIT_ARRAY; | 
|  | else if (strcmp (name, "SHT_FINI_ARRAY") == 0) | 
|  | type = SHT_FINI_ARRAY; | 
|  | else if (strcmp (name, "SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY") == 0) | 
|  | type = SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY; | 
|  | else | 
|  | fatal (_ ("%P: invalid type for output section `%s'\n"), | 
|  | os->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | exp_fold_tree_no_dot (os->sectype_value, os); | 
|  | if (expld.result.valid_p) | 
|  | type = expld.result.value; | 
|  | else | 
|  | fatal (_ ("%P: invalid type for output section `%s'\n"), | 
|  | os->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case noload_section: | 
|  | if (bfd_get_flavour (link_info.output_bfd) | 
|  | == bfd_target_elf_flavour) | 
|  | flags = SEC_NEVER_LOAD | SEC_ALLOC; | 
|  | else | 
|  | flags = SEC_NEVER_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (os->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | init_os (os, flags | SEC_READONLY); | 
|  | else | 
|  | os->bfd_section->flags |= flags; | 
|  | os->bfd_section->type = type; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_section_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_fill_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_object_symbols_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_reloc_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_padding_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_input_statement_enum: | 
|  | if (os != NULL && os->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | init_os (os, 0); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_assignment_statement_enum: | 
|  | if (os != NULL && os->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | init_os (os, get_os_init_flag (os)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure that any sections mentioned in the assignment | 
|  | are initialized.  */ | 
|  | exp_init_os (s->assignment_statement.exp); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_address_statement_enum: | 
|  | /* Mark the specified section with the supplied address. | 
|  | If this section was actually a segment marker, then the | 
|  | directive is ignored if the linker script explicitly | 
|  | processed the segment marker.  Originally, the linker | 
|  | treated segment directives (like -Ttext on the | 
|  | command-line) as section directives.  We honor the | 
|  | section directive semantics for backwards compatibility; | 
|  | linker scripts that do not specifically check for | 
|  | SEGMENT_START automatically get the old semantics.  */ | 
|  | if (!s->address_statement.segment | 
|  | || !s->address_statement.segment->used) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *name = s->address_statement.section_name; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create the output section statement here so that | 
|  | orphans with a set address will be placed after other | 
|  | script sections.  If we let the orphan placement code | 
|  | place them in amongst other sections then the address | 
|  | will affect following script sections, which is | 
|  | likely to surprise naive users.  */ | 
|  | tos = lang_output_section_statement_lookup (name, 0, 1); | 
|  | tos->addr_tree = s->address_statement.address; | 
|  | if (tos->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | init_os (tos, 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_insert_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_matcher_enum: | 
|  | FAIL (); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* An insert statement snips out all the linker statements from the | 
|  | start of the list and places them after the output section | 
|  | statement specified by the insert.  This operation is complicated | 
|  | by the fact that we keep a doubly linked list of output section | 
|  | statements as well as the singly linked list of all statements. | 
|  | FIXME someday: Twiddling with the list not only moves statements | 
|  | from the user's script but also input and group statements that are | 
|  | built from command line object files and --start-group.  We only | 
|  | get away with this because the list pointers used by file_chain | 
|  | and input_file_chain are not reordered, and processing via | 
|  | statement_list after this point mostly ignores input statements. | 
|  | One exception is the map file, where LOAD and START GROUP/END GROUP | 
|  | can end up looking odd.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | process_insert_statements (lang_statement_union_type **start) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **s; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *first_os = NULL; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *last_os = NULL; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | s = start; | 
|  | while (*s != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if ((*s)->header.type == lang_output_section_statement_enum) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Keep pointers to the first and last output section | 
|  | statement in the sequence we may be about to move.  */ | 
|  | os = &(*s)->output_section_statement; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASSERT (last_os == NULL || last_os->next == os); | 
|  | last_os = os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set constraint negative so that lang_output_section_find | 
|  | won't match this output section statement.  At this | 
|  | stage in linking constraint has values in the range | 
|  | [-1, ONLY_IN_RW].  */ | 
|  | last_os->constraint = -2 - last_os->constraint; | 
|  | if (first_os == NULL) | 
|  | first_os = last_os; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if ((*s)->header.type == lang_group_statement_enum) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* A user might put -T between --start-group and | 
|  | --end-group.  One way this odd construct might arise is | 
|  | from a wrapper around ld to change library search | 
|  | behaviour.  For example: | 
|  | #! /bin/sh | 
|  | exec real_ld --start-group "$@" --end-group | 
|  | This isn't completely unreasonable so go looking inside a | 
|  | group statement for insert statements.  */ | 
|  | process_insert_statements (&(*s)->group_statement.children.head); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if ((*s)->header.type == lang_insert_statement_enum) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_insert_statement_type *i = &(*s)->insert_statement; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *where; | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **ptr; | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type *first; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.non_contiguous_regions) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("warning: INSERT statement in linker script is " | 
|  | "incompatible with --enable-non-contiguous-regions.\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | where = lang_output_section_find (i->where); | 
|  | if (where != NULL && i->is_before) | 
|  | { | 
|  | do | 
|  | where = where->prev; | 
|  | while (where != NULL && where->constraint < 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (where == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: %s not found for insert\n"), i->where); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Deal with reordering the output section statement list.  */ | 
|  | if (last_os != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *first_sec, *last_sec; | 
|  | struct lang_output_section_statement_struct **next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Snip out the output sections we are moving.  */ | 
|  | first_os->prev->next = last_os->next; | 
|  | if (last_os->next == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | next = &first_os->prev->next; | 
|  | lang_os_list.tail = (lang_statement_union_type **) next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | last_os->next->prev = first_os->prev; | 
|  | /* Add them in at the new position.  */ | 
|  | last_os->next = where->next; | 
|  | if (where->next == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | next = &last_os->next; | 
|  | lang_os_list.tail = (lang_statement_union_type **) next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | where->next->prev = last_os; | 
|  | first_os->prev = where; | 
|  | where->next = first_os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Move the bfd sections in the same way.  */ | 
|  | first_sec = NULL; | 
|  | last_sec = NULL; | 
|  | for (os = first_os; os != NULL; os = os->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | os->constraint = -2 - os->constraint; | 
|  | if (os->bfd_section != NULL | 
|  | && os->bfd_section->owner != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | last_sec = os->bfd_section; | 
|  | if (first_sec == NULL) | 
|  | first_sec = last_sec; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (os == last_os) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (last_sec != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *sec = where->bfd_section; | 
|  | if (sec == NULL) | 
|  | sec = output_prev_sec_find (where); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The place we want to insert must come after the | 
|  | sections we are moving.  So if we find no | 
|  | section or if the section is the same as our | 
|  | last section, then no move is needed.  */ | 
|  | if (sec != NULL && sec != last_sec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Trim them off.  */ | 
|  | if (first_sec->prev != NULL) | 
|  | first_sec->prev->next = last_sec->next; | 
|  | else | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->sections = last_sec->next; | 
|  | if (last_sec->next != NULL) | 
|  | last_sec->next->prev = first_sec->prev; | 
|  | else | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->section_last = first_sec->prev; | 
|  | /* Add back.  */ | 
|  | if (sec->owner == NULL) | 
|  | /* SEC is the absolute section, from the | 
|  | first dummy output section statement.  Add | 
|  | back the sections we trimmed off to the | 
|  | start of the bfd sections.  */ | 
|  | sec = NULL; | 
|  | if (sec != NULL) | 
|  | last_sec->next = sec->next; | 
|  | else | 
|  | last_sec->next = link_info.output_bfd->sections; | 
|  | if (last_sec->next != NULL) | 
|  | last_sec->next->prev = last_sec; | 
|  | else | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->section_last = last_sec; | 
|  | first_sec->prev = sec; | 
|  | if (first_sec->prev != NULL) | 
|  | first_sec->prev->next = first_sec; | 
|  | else | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->sections = first_sec; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type *after = (void *) where; | 
|  | if (where == &lang_os_list.head->output_section_statement | 
|  | && where->next == first_os) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* PR30155.  Handle a corner case where the statement | 
|  | list is something like the following: | 
|  | . LOAD t.o | 
|  | . .data           0x0000000000000000        0x0 | 
|  | .                 [0x0000000000000000]              b = . | 
|  | .  *(.data) | 
|  | .  .data          0x0000000000000000        0x0 t.o | 
|  | .                 0x0000000000000000        0x4 LONG 0x0 | 
|  | . INSERT BEFORE .text.start | 
|  | .                 [0x0000000000000004]              a = . | 
|  | . .text.start     0x0000000000000000        0x0 | 
|  | .                 [0x0000000000000000]              c = . | 
|  | . OUTPUT(a.out elf64-x86-64) | 
|  | Here we do not want to allow insert_os_after to | 
|  | choose a point inside the list we are moving. | 
|  | That would lose the list.  Instead, let | 
|  | insert_os_after work from the INSERT, which in this | 
|  | particular example will result in inserting after | 
|  | the assignment "a = .".  */ | 
|  | after = *s; | 
|  | } | 
|  | ptr = insert_os_after (after); | 
|  | /* Snip everything from the start of the list, up to and | 
|  | including the insert statement we are currently processing.  */ | 
|  | first = *start; | 
|  | *start = (*s)->header.next; | 
|  | /* Add them back where they belong, minus the insert.  */ | 
|  | *s = *ptr; | 
|  | if (*s == NULL) | 
|  | statement_list.tail = s; | 
|  | *ptr = first; | 
|  | s = start; | 
|  | first_os = NULL; | 
|  | last_os = NULL; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | s = &(*s)->header.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Undo constraint twiddling.  */ | 
|  | for (os = first_os; os != NULL; os = os->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | os->constraint = -2 - os->constraint; | 
|  | if (os == last_os) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* An output section might have been removed after its statement was | 
|  | added.  For example, ldemul_before_allocation can remove dynamic | 
|  | sections if they turn out to be not needed.  Clean them up here.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | strip_excluded_output_sections (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Run lang_size_sections (if not already done).  */ | 
|  | if (expld.phase != lang_mark_phase_enum) | 
|  | { | 
|  | expld.phase = lang_mark_phase_enum; | 
|  | expld.dataseg.phase = exp_seg_none; | 
|  | one_lang_size_sections_pass (NULL, false); | 
|  | lang_reset_memory_regions (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (os = (void *) lang_os_list.head; | 
|  | os != NULL; | 
|  | os = os->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *output_section; | 
|  | bool exclude; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->constraint < 0) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | output_section = os->bfd_section; | 
|  | if (output_section == NULL) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | exclude = (output_section->rawsize == 0 | 
|  | && (output_section->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0 | 
|  | && !bfd_section_removed_from_list (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | output_section)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Some sections have not yet been sized, notably .gnu.version, | 
|  | .dynsym, .dynstr and .hash.  These all have SEC_LINKER_CREATED | 
|  | input sections, so don't drop output sections that have such | 
|  | input sections unless they are also marked SEC_EXCLUDE.  */ | 
|  | if (exclude && output_section->map_head.s != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (s = output_section->map_head.s; s != NULL; s = s->map_head.s) | 
|  | if ((s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 | 
|  | && ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0 | 
|  | || link_info.emitrelocations)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | exclude = false; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (exclude) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We don't set bfd_section to NULL since bfd_section of the | 
|  | removed output section statement may still be used.  */ | 
|  | if (!os->update_dot) | 
|  | os->ignored = true; | 
|  | output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; | 
|  | bfd_section_list_remove (link_info.output_bfd, output_section); | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd->section_count--; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Called from ldwrite to clear out asection.map_head and | 
|  | asection.map_tail for use as link_orders in ldwrite.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_clear_os_map (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (map_head_is_link_order) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (os = (void *) lang_os_list.head; | 
|  | os != NULL; | 
|  | os = os->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *output_section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->constraint < 0) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | output_section = os->bfd_section; | 
|  | if (output_section == NULL) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* TODO: Don't just junk map_head.s, turn them into link_orders.  */ | 
|  | output_section->map_head.link_order = NULL; | 
|  | output_section->map_tail.link_order = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Stop future calls to lang_add_section from messing with map_head | 
|  | and map_tail link_order fields.  */ | 
|  | map_head_is_link_order = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_output_section_statement | 
|  | (lang_output_section_statement_type *output_section_statement) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *section = output_section_statement->bfd_section; | 
|  | int len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (output_section_statement != abs_output_section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | minfo ("\n%s", output_section_statement->name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_dot = section->vma; | 
|  |  | 
|  | len = strlen (output_section_statement->name); | 
|  | if (len >= SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH - 1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  | len = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | print_spaces (SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH - len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | minfo ("0x%V %W", section->vma, TO_ADDR (section->size)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (section->vma != section->lma) | 
|  | minfo (_(" load address 0x%V"), section->lma); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (output_section_statement->update_dot_tree != NULL) | 
|  | exp_fold_tree (output_section_statement->update_dot_tree, | 
|  | output_section_statement, | 
|  | bfd_abs_section_ptr, &print_dot); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_statement_list (output_section_statement->children.head, | 
|  | output_section_statement); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_assignment (lang_assignment_statement_type *assignment, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *output_section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool is_dot; | 
|  | etree_type *tree; | 
|  | asection *osec; | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_spaces (SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (assignment->exp->type.node_class == etree_assert) | 
|  | { | 
|  | is_dot = false; | 
|  | tree = assignment->exp->assert_s.child; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *dst = assignment->exp->assign.dst; | 
|  |  | 
|  | is_dot = (dst[0] == '.' && dst[1] == 0); | 
|  | tree = assignment->exp; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | osec = output_section->bfd_section; | 
|  | if (osec == NULL) | 
|  | osec = bfd_abs_section_ptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (assignment->exp->type.node_class != etree_provide) | 
|  | exp_fold_tree (tree, output_section, osec, &print_dot); | 
|  | else | 
|  | expld.result.valid_p = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | char buf[32]; | 
|  | const char *str = buf; | 
|  | if (expld.result.valid_p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma value; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (assignment->exp->type.node_class == etree_assert | 
|  | || is_dot | 
|  | || expld.assign_name != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | value = expld.result.value; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (expld.result.section != NULL) | 
|  | value += expld.result.section->vma; | 
|  |  | 
|  | buf[0] = '0'; | 
|  | buf[1] = 'x'; | 
|  | bfd_sprintf_vma (link_info.output_bfd, buf + 2, value); | 
|  | if (is_dot) | 
|  | print_dot = value; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h; | 
|  |  | 
|  | h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (link_info.hash, assignment->exp->assign.dst, | 
|  | false, false, true); | 
|  | if (h != NULL | 
|  | && (h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined | 
|  | || h->type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | value = h->u.def.value; | 
|  | value += h->u.def.section->output_section->vma; | 
|  | value += h->u.def.section->output_offset; | 
|  |  | 
|  | buf[0] = '['; | 
|  | buf[1] = '0'; | 
|  | buf[2] = 'x'; | 
|  | bfd_sprintf_vma (link_info.output_bfd, buf + 3, value); | 
|  | strcat (buf, "]"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | str = "[unresolved]"; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (assignment->exp->type.node_class == etree_provide) | 
|  | str = "[!provide]"; | 
|  | else | 
|  | str = "*undef*"; | 
|  | } | 
|  | expld.assign_name = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, "%-34s", str); | 
|  | exp_print_tree (assignment->exp); | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_input_statement (lang_input_statement_type *statm) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (statm->filename != NULL) | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, "LOAD %s\n", statm->filename); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print all symbols defined in a particular section.  This is called | 
|  | via bfd_link_hash_traverse, or by print_all_symbols.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool | 
|  | print_one_symbol (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *hash_entry, void *ptr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *sec = (asection *) ptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((hash_entry->type == bfd_link_hash_defined | 
|  | || hash_entry->type == bfd_link_hash_defweak) | 
|  | && sec == hash_entry->u.def.section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_spaces (SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH); | 
|  | minfo ("0x%V   ", | 
|  | (hash_entry->u.def.value | 
|  | + hash_entry->u.def.section->output_offset | 
|  | + hash_entry->u.def.section->output_section->vma)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | minfo ("             %pT\n", hash_entry->root.string); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | hash_entry_addr_cmp (const void *a, const void *b) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct bfd_link_hash_entry *l = *(const struct bfd_link_hash_entry **)a; | 
|  | const struct bfd_link_hash_entry *r = *(const struct bfd_link_hash_entry **)b; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (l->u.def.value < r->u.def.value) | 
|  | return -1; | 
|  | else if (l->u.def.value > r->u.def.value) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | else | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_all_symbols (asection *sec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | input_section_userdata_type *ud = bfd_section_userdata (sec); | 
|  | struct map_symbol_def *def; | 
|  | struct bfd_link_hash_entry **entries; | 
|  | unsigned int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!ud) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | *ud->map_symbol_def_tail = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Sort the symbols by address.  */ | 
|  | entries = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry **) | 
|  | obstack_alloc (&map_obstack, | 
|  | ud->map_symbol_def_count * sizeof (*entries)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0, def = ud->map_symbol_def_head; def; def = def->next, i++) | 
|  | entries[i] = def->entry; | 
|  |  | 
|  | qsort (entries, ud->map_symbol_def_count, sizeof (*entries), | 
|  | hash_entry_addr_cmp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print the symbols.  */ | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < ud->map_symbol_def_count; i++) | 
|  | ldemul_print_symbol (entries[i], sec); | 
|  |  | 
|  | obstack_free (&map_obstack, entries); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Returns TRUE if SYM is a symbol suitable for printing | 
|  | in a linker map as a local symbol.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | ld_is_local_symbol (asymbol * sym) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char * name = bfd_asymbol_name (sym); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (name == NULL || *name == 0) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Skip .Lxxx and such like.  */ | 
|  | if (bfd_is_local_label (link_info.output_bfd, sym)) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* FIXME: This is intended to skip ARM mapping symbols, | 
|  | which for some reason are not excluded by bfd_is_local_label, | 
|  | but maybe it is wrong for other architectures. | 
|  | It would be better to fix bfd_is_local_label.  */ | 
|  | if (*name == '$') | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Some local symbols, eg _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, are present | 
|  | in the hash table, so do not print duplicates here.  */ | 
|  | struct bfd_link_hash_entry * h; | 
|  | h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (link_info.hash, name, false /* create */, | 
|  | false /* copy */, true /* follow */); | 
|  | if (h == NULL) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Symbols from the plugin owned BFD will not get their own | 
|  | iteration of this function, but can be on the link_info | 
|  | list.  So include them here.  */ | 
|  | if (h->u.def.section->owner != NULL | 
|  | && ((bfd_get_file_flags (h->u.def.section->owner) & (BFD_LINKER_CREATED | BFD_PLUGIN)) | 
|  | == (BFD_LINKER_CREATED | BFD_PLUGIN))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print information about an input section to the map file.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_input_section (asection *i, bool is_discarded) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_size_type size = i->size; | 
|  | int len; | 
|  | bfd_vma addr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_opb (i); | 
|  |  | 
|  | minfo (" %s", i->name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | len = 1 + strlen (i->name); | 
|  | if (len >= SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH - 1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  | len = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | print_spaces (SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH - len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (i->output_section != NULL | 
|  | && i->output_section->owner == link_info.output_bfd) | 
|  | addr = i->output_section->vma + i->output_offset; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | addr = print_dot; | 
|  | if (!is_discarded) | 
|  | size = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | char buf[32]; | 
|  | bfd_sprintf_vma (link_info.output_bfd, buf, addr); | 
|  | minfo ("0x%s %W %pB\n", buf, TO_ADDR (size), i->owner); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (size != i->rawsize && i->rawsize != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | len = SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH + 3 + strlen (buf); | 
|  | print_spaces (len); | 
|  | minfo (_("%W (size before relaxing)\n"), TO_ADDR (i->rawsize)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (i->output_section != NULL | 
|  | && i->output_section->owner == link_info.output_bfd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (link_info.reduce_memory_overheads) | 
|  | bfd_link_hash_traverse (link_info.hash, ldemul_print_symbol, i); | 
|  | else | 
|  | print_all_symbols (i); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update print_dot, but make sure that we do not move it | 
|  | backwards - this could happen if we have overlays and a | 
|  | later overlay is shorter than an earier one.  */ | 
|  | if (addr + TO_ADDR (size) > print_dot) | 
|  | print_dot = addr + TO_ADDR (size); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.print_map_locals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | long  storage_needed; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* FIXME: It would be better to cache this table, rather | 
|  | than recreating it for each output section.  */ | 
|  | /* FIXME: This call is not working for non-ELF based targets. | 
|  | Find out why.  */ | 
|  | storage_needed = bfd_get_symtab_upper_bound (link_info.output_bfd); | 
|  | if (storage_needed > 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asymbol **  symbol_table; | 
|  | long        number_of_symbols; | 
|  | long        j; | 
|  |  | 
|  | symbol_table = xmalloc (storage_needed); | 
|  | number_of_symbols = bfd_canonicalize_symtab (link_info.output_bfd, symbol_table); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (j = 0; j < number_of_symbols; j++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asymbol *     sym = symbol_table[j]; | 
|  | bfd_vma       sym_addr = sym->value + i->output_section->vma; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sym->section == i->output_section | 
|  | && (sym->flags & BSF_LOCAL) != 0 | 
|  | && sym_addr >= addr | 
|  | && sym_addr < print_dot | 
|  | && ld_is_local_symbol (sym)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_spaces (SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH); | 
|  | minfo ("0x%V        (local) %s\n", sym_addr, bfd_asymbol_name (sym)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | free (symbol_table); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_fill_statement (lang_fill_statement_type *fill) | 
|  | { | 
|  | size_t size; | 
|  | unsigned char *p; | 
|  | fputs (" FILL mask 0x", config.map_file); | 
|  | for (p = fill->fill->data, size = fill->fill->size; size != 0; p++, size--) | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, "%02x", *p); | 
|  | fputs ("\n", config.map_file); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_data_statement (lang_data_statement_type *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma addr; | 
|  | bfd_size_type size; | 
|  | const char *name; | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_opb (data->output_section); | 
|  | print_spaces (SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH); | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr = data->output_offset; | 
|  | if (data->output_section != NULL) | 
|  | addr += data->output_section->vma; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (data->type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | case BYTE: | 
|  | size = BYTE_SIZE; | 
|  | name = "BYTE"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case SHORT: | 
|  | size = SHORT_SIZE; | 
|  | name = "SHORT"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case LONG: | 
|  | size = LONG_SIZE; | 
|  | name = "LONG"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case QUAD: | 
|  | size = QUAD_SIZE; | 
|  | name = "QUAD"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case SQUAD: | 
|  | size = QUAD_SIZE; | 
|  | name = "SQUAD"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (size < TO_SIZE ((unsigned) 1)) | 
|  | size = TO_SIZE ((unsigned) 1); | 
|  | minfo ("0x%V %W %s 0x%v", addr, TO_ADDR (size), name, data->value); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (data->exp->type.node_class != etree_value) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_space (); | 
|  | exp_print_tree (data->exp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_dot = addr + TO_ADDR (size); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print an address statement.  These are generated by options like | 
|  | -Ttext.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_address_statement (lang_address_statement_type *address) | 
|  | { | 
|  | minfo (_("Address of section %s set to "), address->section_name); | 
|  | exp_print_tree (address->address); | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print a reloc statement.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_reloc_statement (lang_reloc_statement_type *reloc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma addr; | 
|  | bfd_size_type size; | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_opb (reloc->output_section); | 
|  | print_spaces (SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH); | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr = reloc->output_offset; | 
|  | if (reloc->output_section != NULL) | 
|  | addr += reloc->output_section->vma; | 
|  |  | 
|  | size = bfd_get_reloc_size (reloc->howto); | 
|  |  | 
|  | minfo ("0x%V %W RELOC %s ", addr, TO_ADDR (size), reloc->howto->name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (reloc->name != NULL) | 
|  | minfo ("%s+", reloc->name); | 
|  | else | 
|  | minfo ("%s+", reloc->section->name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | exp_print_tree (reloc->addend_exp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_dot = addr + TO_ADDR (size); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_padding_statement (lang_padding_statement_type *s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int len; | 
|  | bfd_vma addr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | init_opb (s->output_section); | 
|  | minfo (" *fill*"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | len = sizeof " *fill*" - 1; | 
|  | print_spaces (SECTION_NAME_MAP_LENGTH - len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | addr = s->output_offset; | 
|  | if (s->output_section != NULL) | 
|  | addr += s->output_section->vma; | 
|  | minfo ("0x%V %W ", addr, TO_ADDR (s->size)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (s->fill->size != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | size_t size; | 
|  | unsigned char *p; | 
|  | for (p = s->fill->data, size = s->fill->size; size != 0; p++, size--) | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, "%02x", *p); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_dot = addr + TO_ADDR (s->size); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_wild_statement (lang_wild_statement_type *w, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec; | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_space (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (w->exclude_name_list) | 
|  | { | 
|  | name_list *tmp; | 
|  | minfo ("EXCLUDE_FILE(%s", w->exclude_name_list->name); | 
|  | for (tmp = w->exclude_name_list->next; tmp; tmp = tmp->next) | 
|  | minfo (" %s", tmp->name); | 
|  | minfo (") "); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (w->filenames_sorted) | 
|  | minfo ("SORT_BY_NAME("); | 
|  | if (w->filenames_reversed) | 
|  | minfo ("REVERSE("); | 
|  | if (w->filename != NULL) | 
|  | minfo ("%s", w->filename); | 
|  | else | 
|  | minfo ("*"); | 
|  | if (w->filenames_reversed) | 
|  | minfo (")"); | 
|  | if (w->filenames_sorted) | 
|  | minfo (")"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | minfo ("("); | 
|  | for (sec = w->section_list; sec; sec = sec->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | int closing_paren = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (sec->spec.sorted) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case none: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_name: | 
|  | minfo ("SORT_BY_NAME("); | 
|  | closing_paren = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_alignment: | 
|  | minfo ("SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT("); | 
|  | closing_paren = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_name_alignment: | 
|  | minfo ("SORT_BY_NAME(SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT("); | 
|  | closing_paren = 2; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_alignment_name: | 
|  | minfo ("SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT(SORT_BY_NAME("); | 
|  | closing_paren = 2; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_none: | 
|  | minfo ("SORT_NONE("); | 
|  | closing_paren = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case by_init_priority: | 
|  | minfo ("SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY("); | 
|  | closing_paren = 1; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sec->spec.reversed) | 
|  | { | 
|  | minfo ("REVERSE("); | 
|  | closing_paren++; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sec->spec.exclude_name_list != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | name_list *tmp; | 
|  | minfo ("EXCLUDE_FILE(%s", sec->spec.exclude_name_list->name); | 
|  | for (tmp = sec->spec.exclude_name_list->next; tmp; tmp = tmp->next) | 
|  | minfo (" %s", tmp->name); | 
|  | minfo (") "); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (sec->spec.name != NULL) | 
|  | minfo ("%s", sec->spec.name); | 
|  | else | 
|  | minfo ("*"); | 
|  | for (;closing_paren > 0; closing_paren--) | 
|  | minfo (")"); | 
|  | if (sec->next) | 
|  | minfo (" "); | 
|  | } | 
|  | minfo (")"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | print_statement_list (w->children.head, os); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print a group statement.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_group (lang_group_statement_type *s, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, "START GROUP\n"); | 
|  | print_statement_list (s->children.head, os); | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, "END GROUP\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print the list of statements in S. | 
|  | This can be called for any statement type.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_statement_list (lang_statement_union_type *s, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os) | 
|  | { | 
|  | while (s != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_statement (s, os); | 
|  | s = s->header.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print the first statement in statement list S. | 
|  | This can be called for any statement type.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_statement (lang_statement_union_type *s, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (s->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, _("Fail with %d\n"), s->header.type); | 
|  | FAIL (); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | if (constructor_list.head != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (constructors_sorted) | 
|  | minfo (" SORT (CONSTRUCTORS)\n"); | 
|  | else | 
|  | minfo (" CONSTRUCTORS\n"); | 
|  | print_statement_list (constructor_list.head, os); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | print_wild_statement (&s->wild_statement, os); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_address_statement_enum: | 
|  | print_address_statement (&s->address_statement); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_object_symbols_statement_enum: | 
|  | minfo (" CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS\n"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_fill_statement_enum: | 
|  | print_fill_statement (&s->fill_statement); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_data_statement_enum: | 
|  | print_data_statement (&s->data_statement); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_reloc_statement_enum: | 
|  | print_reloc_statement (&s->reloc_statement); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_section_enum: | 
|  | print_input_section (s->input_section.section, false); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_padding_statement_enum: | 
|  | print_padding_statement (&s->padding_statement); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | print_output_section_statement (&s->output_section_statement); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_assignment_statement_enum: | 
|  | print_assignment (&s->assignment_statement, os); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_target_statement_enum: | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, "TARGET(%s)\n", s->target_statement.target); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_output_statement_enum: | 
|  | minfo ("OUTPUT(%s", s->output_statement.name); | 
|  | if (output_target != NULL) | 
|  | minfo (" %s", output_target); | 
|  | minfo (")\n"); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_input_statement_enum: | 
|  | print_input_statement (&s->input_statement); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | print_group (&s->group_statement, os); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_insert_statement_enum: | 
|  | minfo ("INSERT %s %s\n", | 
|  | s->insert_statement.is_before ? "BEFORE" : "AFTER", | 
|  | s->insert_statement.where); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_statements (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_statement_list (statement_list.head, abs_output_section); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Print the first N statements in statement list S to STDERR. | 
|  | If N == 0, nothing is printed. | 
|  | If N < 0, the entire list is printed. | 
|  | Intended to be called from GDB.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | dprint_statement (lang_statement_union_type *s, int n) | 
|  | { | 
|  | FILE *map_save = config.map_file; | 
|  |  | 
|  | config.map_file = stderr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (n < 0) | 
|  | print_statement_list (s, abs_output_section); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | while (s && --n >= 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_statement (s, abs_output_section); | 
|  | s = s->header.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | config.map_file = map_save; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | insert_pad (lang_statement_union_type **ptr, | 
|  | fill_type *fill, | 
|  | bfd_size_type alignment_needed, | 
|  | asection *output_section, | 
|  | bfd_vma dot) | 
|  | { | 
|  | static fill_type zero_fill; | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type *pad = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ptr != &statement_list.head) | 
|  | pad = ((lang_statement_union_type *) | 
|  | ((char *) ptr - offsetof (lang_statement_union_type, header.next))); | 
|  | if (pad != NULL | 
|  | && pad->header.type == lang_padding_statement_enum | 
|  | && pad->padding_statement.output_section == output_section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Use the existing pad statement.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if ((pad = *ptr) != NULL | 
|  | && pad->header.type == lang_padding_statement_enum | 
|  | && pad->padding_statement.output_section == output_section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Use the existing pad statement.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Make a new padding statement, linked into existing chain.  */ | 
|  | pad = stat_alloc (sizeof (lang_padding_statement_type)); | 
|  | pad->header.next = *ptr; | 
|  | *ptr = pad; | 
|  | pad->header.type = lang_padding_statement_enum; | 
|  | pad->padding_statement.output_section = output_section; | 
|  | if (fill == NULL) | 
|  | fill = &zero_fill; | 
|  | pad->padding_statement.fill = fill; | 
|  | } | 
|  | pad->padding_statement.output_offset = dot - output_section->vma; | 
|  | pad->padding_statement.size = alignment_needed; | 
|  | if (!(output_section->flags & SEC_FIXED_SIZE)) | 
|  | output_section->size = TO_SIZE (dot + TO_ADDR (alignment_needed) | 
|  | - output_section->vma); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Work out how much this section will move the dot point.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bfd_vma | 
|  | size_input_section | 
|  | (lang_statement_union_type **this_ptr, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *output_section_statement, | 
|  | fill_type *fill, | 
|  | bool *removed, | 
|  | bfd_vma dot) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_section_type *is = &((*this_ptr)->input_section); | 
|  | asection *i = is->section; | 
|  | asection *o = output_section_statement->bfd_section; | 
|  | *removed = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.non_contiguous_regions) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If the input section I has already been successfully assigned | 
|  | to an output section other than O, don't bother with it and | 
|  | let the caller remove it from the list.  Keep processing in | 
|  | case we have already handled O, because the repeated passes | 
|  | have reinitialized its size.  */ | 
|  | if (i->already_assigned && i->already_assigned != o) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *removed = 1; | 
|  | return dot; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (i->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS) | 
|  | i->output_offset = i->vma - o->vma; | 
|  | else if (((i->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0) | 
|  | || output_section_statement->ignored) | 
|  | i->output_offset = dot - o->vma; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_size_type alignment_needed; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Align this section first to the input sections requirement, | 
|  | then to the output section's requirement.  If this alignment | 
|  | is greater than any seen before, then record it too.  Perform | 
|  | the alignment by inserting a magic 'padding' statement. | 
|  | We can force input section alignment within an output section | 
|  | by using SUBALIGN.  The value specified overrides any alignment | 
|  | given by input sections, whether larger or smaller.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (output_section_statement->subsection_alignment != NULL) | 
|  | o->alignment_power = i->alignment_power = | 
|  | exp_get_power (output_section_statement->subsection_alignment, | 
|  | output_section_statement, | 
|  | "subsection alignment"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (o->alignment_power < i->alignment_power) | 
|  | o->alignment_power = i->alignment_power; | 
|  |  | 
|  | alignment_needed = align_power (dot, i->alignment_power) - dot; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (alignment_needed != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | insert_pad (this_ptr, fill, TO_SIZE (alignment_needed), o, dot); | 
|  | dot += alignment_needed; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.non_contiguous_regions) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If I would overflow O, let the caller remove I from the | 
|  | list.  */ | 
|  | if (output_section_statement->region) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma end = output_section_statement->region->origin | 
|  | + output_section_statement->region->length; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (dot + TO_ADDR (i->size) > end) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (i->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: Output section `%pA' not large enough for " | 
|  | "the linker-created stubs section `%pA'.\n"), | 
|  | i->output_section, i); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (i->rawsize && i->rawsize != i->size) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: Relaxation not supported with " | 
|  | "--enable-non-contiguous-regions (section `%pA' " | 
|  | "would overflow `%pA' after it changed size).\n"), | 
|  | i, i->output_section); | 
|  |  | 
|  | *removed = 1; | 
|  | dot = end; | 
|  | i->output_section = NULL; | 
|  | return dot; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remember where in the output section this input section goes.  */ | 
|  | i->output_offset = dot - o->vma; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Mark how big the output section must be to contain this now.  */ | 
|  | dot += TO_ADDR (i->size); | 
|  | if (!(o->flags & SEC_FIXED_SIZE)) | 
|  | o->size = TO_SIZE (dot - o->vma); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.non_contiguous_regions) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Record that I was successfully assigned to O, and update | 
|  | its actual output section too.  */ | 
|  | i->already_assigned = o; | 
|  | i->output_section = o; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return dot; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct check_sec | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *sec; | 
|  | bool warned; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | sort_sections_by_lma (const void *arg1, const void *arg2) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const asection *sec1 = ((const struct check_sec *) arg1)->sec; | 
|  | const asection *sec2 = ((const struct check_sec *) arg2)->sec; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma) | 
|  | return -1; | 
|  | else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | else if (sec1->id < sec2->id) | 
|  | return -1; | 
|  | else if (sec1->id > sec2->id) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | sort_sections_by_vma (const void *arg1, const void *arg2) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const asection *sec1 = ((const struct check_sec *) arg1)->sec; | 
|  | const asection *sec2 = ((const struct check_sec *) arg2)->sec; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma) | 
|  | return -1; | 
|  | else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | else if (sec1->id < sec2->id) | 
|  | return -1; | 
|  | else if (sec1->id > sec2->id) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define IS_TBSS(s) \ | 
|  | ((s->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define IGNORE_SECTION(s) \ | 
|  | ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0 || IS_TBSS (s)) | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check to see if any allocated sections overlap with other allocated | 
|  | sections.  This can happen if a linker script specifies the output | 
|  | section addresses of the two sections.  Also check whether any memory | 
|  | region has overflowed.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_check_section_addresses (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *s, *p; | 
|  | struct check_sec *sections; | 
|  | size_t i, count; | 
|  | bfd_vma addr_mask; | 
|  | bfd_vma s_start; | 
|  | bfd_vma s_end; | 
|  | bfd_vma p_start = 0; | 
|  | bfd_vma p_end = 0; | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *m; | 
|  | bool overlays; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Detect address space overflow on allocated sections.  */ | 
|  | addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << | 
|  | (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (link_info.output_bfd) - 1)) - 1; | 
|  | addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1; | 
|  | for (s = link_info.output_bfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) | 
|  | if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | s_end = (s->vma + s->size) & addr_mask; | 
|  | if (s_end != 0 && s_end < (s->vma & addr_mask)) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: section %s VMA wraps around address space\n"), | 
|  | s->name); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | s_end = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask; | 
|  | if (s_end != 0 && s_end < (s->lma & addr_mask)) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: section %s LMA wraps around address space\n"), | 
|  | s->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bfd_count_sections (link_info.output_bfd) <= 1) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | count = bfd_count_sections (link_info.output_bfd); | 
|  | sections = XNEWVEC (struct check_sec, count); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Scan all sections in the output list.  */ | 
|  | count = 0; | 
|  | for (s = link_info.output_bfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (IGNORE_SECTION (s) | 
|  | || s->size == 0) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | sections[count].sec = s; | 
|  | sections[count].warned = false; | 
|  | count++; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (count <= 1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | free (sections); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | qsort (sections, count, sizeof (*sections), sort_sections_by_lma); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* First check section LMAs.  There should be no overlap of LMAs on | 
|  | loadable sections, even with overlays.  */ | 
|  | for (p = NULL, i = 0; i < count; i++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | s = sections[i].sec; | 
|  | init_opb (s); | 
|  | if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | s_start = s->lma; | 
|  | s_end = s_start + TO_ADDR (s->size) - 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look for an overlap.  We have sorted sections by lma, so | 
|  | we know that s_start >= p_start.  Besides the obvious | 
|  | case of overlap when the current section starts before | 
|  | the previous one ends, we also must have overlap if the | 
|  | previous section wraps around the address space.  */ | 
|  | if (p != NULL | 
|  | && (s_start <= p_end | 
|  | || p_end < p_start)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: section %s LMA [%V,%V]" | 
|  | " overlaps section %s LMA [%V,%V]\n"), | 
|  | s->name, s_start, s_end, p->name, p_start, p_end); | 
|  | sections[i].warned = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | p = s; | 
|  | p_start = s_start; | 
|  | p_end = s_end; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If any non-zero size allocated section (excluding tbss) starts at | 
|  | exactly the same VMA as another such section, then we have | 
|  | overlays.  Overlays generated by the OVERLAY keyword will have | 
|  | this property.  It is possible to intentionally generate overlays | 
|  | that fail this test, but it would be unusual.  */ | 
|  | qsort (sections, count, sizeof (*sections), sort_sections_by_vma); | 
|  | overlays = false; | 
|  | p_start = sections[0].sec->vma; | 
|  | for (i = 1; i < count; i++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | s_start = sections[i].sec->vma; | 
|  | if (p_start == s_start) | 
|  | { | 
|  | overlays = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | p_start = s_start; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now check section VMAs if no overlays were detected.  */ | 
|  | if (!overlays) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (p = NULL, i = 0; i < count; i++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | s = sections[i].sec; | 
|  | init_opb (s); | 
|  | s_start = s->vma; | 
|  | s_end = s_start + TO_ADDR (s->size) - 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (p != NULL | 
|  | && !sections[i].warned | 
|  | && (s_start <= p_end | 
|  | || p_end < p_start)) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: section %s VMA [%V,%V]" | 
|  | " overlaps section %s VMA [%V,%V]\n"), | 
|  | s->name, s_start, s_end, p->name, p_start, p_end); | 
|  | p = s; | 
|  | p_start = s_start; | 
|  | p_end = s_end; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | free (sections); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If any memory region has overflowed, report by how much. | 
|  | We do not issue this diagnostic for regions that had sections | 
|  | explicitly placed outside their bounds; os_region_check's | 
|  | diagnostics are adequate for that case. | 
|  |  | 
|  | FIXME: It is conceivable that m->current - (m->origin + m->length) | 
|  | might overflow a 32-bit integer.  There is, alas, no way to print | 
|  | a bfd_vma quantity in decimal.  */ | 
|  | for (m = lang_memory_region_list; m; m = m->next) | 
|  | if (m->had_full_message) | 
|  | { | 
|  | unsigned long over = m->current - (m->origin + m->length); | 
|  | einfo (ngettext ("%X%P: region `%s' overflowed by %lu byte\n", | 
|  | "%X%P: region `%s' overflowed by %lu bytes\n", | 
|  | over), | 
|  | m->name_list.name, over); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure the new address is within the region.  We explicitly permit the | 
|  | current address to be at the exact end of the region when the address is | 
|  | non-zero, in case the region is at the end of addressable memory and the | 
|  | calculation wraps around.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | os_region_check (lang_output_section_statement_type *os, | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *region, | 
|  | etree_type *tree, | 
|  | bfd_vma rbase) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if ((region->current < region->origin | 
|  | || (region->current - region->origin > region->length)) | 
|  | && ((region->current != region->origin + region->length) | 
|  | || rbase == 0)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (tree != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: address 0x%v of %pB section `%s'" | 
|  | " is not within region `%s'\n"), | 
|  | region->current, | 
|  | os->bfd_section->owner, | 
|  | os->bfd_section->name, | 
|  | region->name_list.name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (!region->had_full_message) | 
|  | { | 
|  | region->had_full_message = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: %pB section `%s' will not fit in region `%s'\n"), | 
|  | os->bfd_section->owner, | 
|  | os->bfd_section->name, | 
|  | region->name_list.name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | ldlang_check_relro_region (lang_statement_union_type *s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | seg_align_type *seg = &expld.dataseg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (seg->relro == exp_seg_relro_start) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!seg->relro_start_stat) | 
|  | seg->relro_start_stat = s; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | ASSERT (seg->relro_start_stat == s); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (seg->relro == exp_seg_relro_end) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!seg->relro_end_stat) | 
|  | seg->relro_end_stat = s; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | ASSERT (seg->relro_end_stat == s); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the sizes for all the output sections.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bfd_vma | 
|  | lang_size_sections_1 | 
|  | (lang_statement_union_type **prev, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *current_os, | 
|  | fill_type *fill, | 
|  | bfd_vma dot, | 
|  | bool *relax, | 
|  | bool check_regions) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type *s; | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type *prev_s = NULL; | 
|  | bool removed_prev_s = false; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os = current_os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Size up the sections from their constituent parts.  */ | 
|  | for (s = *prev; s != NULL; prev_s = s, s = s->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool removed = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (s->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma newdot, after, dotdelta; | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *r; | 
|  | int section_alignment = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os = &s->output_section_statement; | 
|  | init_opb (os->bfd_section); | 
|  | if (os->constraint == -1) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* FIXME: We shouldn't need to zero section vmas for ld -r | 
|  | here, in lang_insert_orphan, or in the default linker scripts. | 
|  | This is covering for coff backend linker bugs.  See PR6945.  */ | 
|  | if (os->addr_tree == NULL | 
|  | && bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) | 
|  | && (bfd_get_flavour (link_info.output_bfd) | 
|  | == bfd_target_coff_flavour)) | 
|  | os->addr_tree = exp_intop (0); | 
|  | if (os->addr_tree != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | exp_fold_tree (os->addr_tree, os, bfd_abs_section_ptr, &dot); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (expld.result.valid_p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | dot = expld.result.value; | 
|  | if (expld.result.section != NULL) | 
|  | dot += expld.result.section->vma; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (expld.phase != lang_mark_phase_enum) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P:%pS: non constant or forward reference" | 
|  | " address expression for section %s\n"), | 
|  | os->addr_tree, os->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | /* This section was removed or never actually created.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this is a COFF shared library section, use the size and | 
|  | address from the input section.  FIXME: This is COFF | 
|  | specific; it would be cleaner if there were some other way | 
|  | to do this, but nothing simple comes to mind.  */ | 
|  | if (((bfd_get_flavour (link_info.output_bfd) | 
|  | == bfd_target_ecoff_flavour) | 
|  | || (bfd_get_flavour (link_info.output_bfd) | 
|  | == bfd_target_coff_flavour)) | 
|  | && (os->bfd_section->flags & SEC_COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *input; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->children.head == NULL | 
|  | || os->children.head->header.next != NULL | 
|  | || (os->children.head->header.type | 
|  | != lang_input_section_enum)) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: internal error on COFF shared library" | 
|  | " section %s\n"), os->name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | input = os->children.head->input_section.section; | 
|  | bfd_set_section_vma (os->bfd_section, | 
|  | bfd_section_vma (input)); | 
|  | if (!(os->bfd_section->flags & SEC_FIXED_SIZE)) | 
|  | os->bfd_section->size = input->size; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | newdot = dot; | 
|  | dotdelta = 0; | 
|  | if (bfd_is_abs_section (os->bfd_section)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* No matter what happens, an abs section starts at zero.  */ | 
|  | ASSERT (os->bfd_section->vma == 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (os->addr_tree == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* No address specified for this section, get one | 
|  | from the region specification.  */ | 
|  | if (os->region == NULL | 
|  | || ((os->bfd_section->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD)) | 
|  | && os->region->name_list.name[0] == '*' | 
|  | && strcmp (os->region->name_list.name, | 
|  | DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION) == 0)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | os->region = lang_memory_default (os->bfd_section); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If a loadable section is using the default memory | 
|  | region, and some non default memory regions were | 
|  | defined, issue an error message.  */ | 
|  | if (!os->ignored | 
|  | && !IGNORE_SECTION (os->bfd_section) | 
|  | && !bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) | 
|  | && check_regions | 
|  | && strcmp (os->region->name_list.name, | 
|  | DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION) == 0 | 
|  | && lang_memory_region_list != NULL | 
|  | && (strcmp (lang_memory_region_list->name_list.name, | 
|  | DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION) != 0 | 
|  | || lang_memory_region_list->next != NULL) | 
|  | && lang_sizing_iteration == 1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* By default this is an error rather than just a | 
|  | warning because if we allocate the section to the | 
|  | default memory region we can end up creating an | 
|  | excessively large binary, or even seg faulting when | 
|  | attempting to perform a negative seek.  See | 
|  | sources.redhat.com/ml/binutils/2003-04/msg00423.html | 
|  | for an example of this.  This behaviour can be | 
|  | overridden by the using the --no-check-sections | 
|  | switch.  */ | 
|  | if (command_line.check_section_addresses) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: error: no memory region specified" | 
|  | " for loadable section `%s'\n"), | 
|  | bfd_section_name (os->bfd_section)); | 
|  | else | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: no memory region specified" | 
|  | " for loadable section `%s'\n"), | 
|  | bfd_section_name (os->bfd_section)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | newdot = os->region->current; | 
|  | section_alignment = os->bfd_section->alignment_power; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | section_alignment = exp_get_power (os->section_alignment, os, | 
|  | "section alignment"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Align to what the section needs.  */ | 
|  | if (section_alignment > 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma savedot = newdot; | 
|  | bfd_vma diff = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | newdot = align_power (newdot, section_alignment); | 
|  | dotdelta = newdot - savedot; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (lang_sizing_iteration == 1) | 
|  | diff = dotdelta; | 
|  | else if (lang_sizing_iteration > 1) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Only report adjustments that would change | 
|  | alignment from what we have already reported.  */ | 
|  | diff = newdot - os->bfd_section->vma; | 
|  | if (!(diff & (((bfd_vma) 1 << section_alignment) - 1))) | 
|  | diff = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (diff != 0 | 
|  | && (config.warn_section_align | 
|  | || os->addr_tree != NULL)) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: " | 
|  | "start of section %s changed by %ld\n"), | 
|  | os->name, (long) diff); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bfd_set_section_vma (os->bfd_section, newdot); | 
|  |  | 
|  | os->bfd_section->output_offset = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_size_sections_1 (&os->children.head, os, | 
|  | os->fill, newdot, relax, check_regions); | 
|  |  | 
|  | os->processed_vma = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bfd_is_abs_section (os->bfd_section) || os->ignored) | 
|  | /* Except for some special linker created sections, | 
|  | no output section should change from zero size | 
|  | after strip_excluded_output_sections.  A non-zero | 
|  | size on an ignored section indicates that some | 
|  | input section was not sized early enough.  */ | 
|  | ASSERT (os->bfd_section->size == 0); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | dot = os->bfd_section->vma; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Put the section within the requested block size, or | 
|  | align at the block boundary.  */ | 
|  | after = ((dot | 
|  | + TO_ADDR (os->bfd_section->size) | 
|  | + os->block_value - 1) | 
|  | & - (bfd_vma) os->block_value); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!(os->bfd_section->flags & SEC_FIXED_SIZE)) | 
|  | os->bfd_section->size = TO_SIZE (after | 
|  | - os->bfd_section->vma); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set section lma.  */ | 
|  | r = os->region; | 
|  | if (r == NULL) | 
|  | r = lang_memory_region_lookup (DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION, false); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->load_base) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma lma = exp_get_abs_int (os->load_base, 0, "load base"); | 
|  | os->bfd_section->lma = lma; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (os->lma_region != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma lma = os->lma_region->current; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->align_lma_with_input) | 
|  | lma += dotdelta; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* When LMA_REGION is the same as REGION, align the LMA | 
|  | as we did for the VMA, possibly including alignment | 
|  | from the bfd section.  If a different region, then | 
|  | only align according to the value in the output | 
|  | statement.  */ | 
|  | if (os->lma_region != os->region) | 
|  | section_alignment = exp_get_power (os->section_alignment, | 
|  | os, | 
|  | "section alignment"); | 
|  | if (section_alignment > 0) | 
|  | lma = align_power (lma, section_alignment); | 
|  | } | 
|  | os->bfd_section->lma = lma; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (r->last_os != NULL | 
|  | && (os->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma lma; | 
|  | asection *last; | 
|  |  | 
|  | last = r->last_os->output_section_statement.bfd_section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A backwards move of dot should be accompanied by | 
|  | an explicit assignment to the section LMA (ie. | 
|  | os->load_base set) because backwards moves can | 
|  | create overlapping LMAs.  */ | 
|  | if (dot < last->vma | 
|  | && os->bfd_section->size != 0 | 
|  | && dot + TO_ADDR (os->bfd_section->size) <= last->vma) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If dot moved backwards then leave lma equal to | 
|  | vma.  This is the old default lma, which might | 
|  | just happen to work when the backwards move is | 
|  | sufficiently large.  Nag if this changes anything, | 
|  | so people can fix their linker scripts.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (last->vma != last->lma) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: dot moved backwards " | 
|  | "before `%s'\n"), os->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If this is an overlay, set the current lma to that | 
|  | at the end of the previous section.  */ | 
|  | if (os->sectype == overlay_section) | 
|  | lma = last->lma + TO_ADDR (last->size); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Otherwise, keep the same lma to vma relationship | 
|  | as the previous section.  */ | 
|  | else | 
|  | lma = os->bfd_section->vma + last->lma - last->vma; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (section_alignment > 0) | 
|  | lma = align_power (lma, section_alignment); | 
|  | os->bfd_section->lma = lma; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | os->processed_lma = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Keep track of normal sections using the default | 
|  | lma region.  We use this to set the lma for | 
|  | following sections.  Overlays or other linker | 
|  | script assignment to lma might mean that the | 
|  | default lma == vma is incorrect. | 
|  | To avoid warnings about dot moving backwards when using | 
|  | -Ttext, don't start tracking sections until we find one | 
|  | of non-zero size or with lma set differently to vma. | 
|  | Do this tracking before we short-cut the loop so that we | 
|  | track changes for the case where the section size is zero, | 
|  | but the lma is set differently to the vma.  This is | 
|  | important, if an orphan section is placed after an | 
|  | otherwise empty output section that has an explicit lma | 
|  | set, we want that lma reflected in the orphans lma.  */ | 
|  | if (((!IGNORE_SECTION (os->bfd_section) | 
|  | && (os->bfd_section->size != 0 | 
|  | || (r->last_os == NULL | 
|  | && os->bfd_section->vma != os->bfd_section->lma) | 
|  | || (r->last_os != NULL | 
|  | && dot >= (r->last_os->output_section_statement | 
|  | .bfd_section->vma)))) | 
|  | || os->sectype == first_overlay_section) | 
|  | && os->lma_region == NULL | 
|  | && !bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | r->last_os = s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bfd_is_abs_section (os->bfd_section) || os->ignored) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size.  */ | 
|  | if (!IS_TBSS (os->bfd_section) | 
|  | || bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | dotdelta = TO_ADDR (os->bfd_section->size); | 
|  | else | 
|  | dotdelta = 0; | 
|  | dot += dotdelta; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->update_dot_tree != 0) | 
|  | exp_fold_tree (os->update_dot_tree, os, bfd_abs_section_ptr, &dot); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update dot in the region ? | 
|  | We only do this if the section is going to be allocated, | 
|  | since unallocated sections do not contribute to the region's | 
|  | overall size in memory.  */ | 
|  | if (os->region != NULL | 
|  | && (os->bfd_section->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | os->region->current = dot; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (check_regions) | 
|  | /* Make sure the new address is within the region.  */ | 
|  | os_region_check (os, os->region, os->addr_tree, | 
|  | os->bfd_section->vma); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->lma_region != NULL && os->lma_region != os->region | 
|  | && ((os->bfd_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) | 
|  | || os->align_lma_with_input)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | os->lma_region->current = os->bfd_section->lma + dotdelta; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (check_regions) | 
|  | os_region_check (os, os->lma_region, NULL, | 
|  | os->bfd_section->lma); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | dot = lang_size_sections_1 (&constructor_list.head, current_os, | 
|  | fill, dot, relax, check_regions); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_data_statement_enum: | 
|  | { | 
|  | unsigned int size = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | s->data_statement.output_offset = dot - current_os->bfd_section->vma; | 
|  | s->data_statement.output_section = current_os->bfd_section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We might refer to provided symbols in the expression, and | 
|  | need to mark them as needed.  */ | 
|  | exp_fold_tree (s->data_statement.exp, os, | 
|  | bfd_abs_section_ptr, &dot); | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (s->data_statement.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | case QUAD: | 
|  | case SQUAD: | 
|  | size = QUAD_SIZE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case LONG: | 
|  | size = LONG_SIZE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case SHORT: | 
|  | size = SHORT_SIZE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case BYTE: | 
|  | size = BYTE_SIZE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (size < TO_SIZE ((unsigned) 1)) | 
|  | size = TO_SIZE ((unsigned) 1); | 
|  | dot += TO_ADDR (size); | 
|  | if (!(current_os->bfd_section->flags & SEC_FIXED_SIZE)) | 
|  | current_os->bfd_section->size | 
|  | = TO_SIZE (dot - current_os->bfd_section->vma); | 
|  |  | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_reloc_statement_enum: | 
|  | { | 
|  | int size; | 
|  |  | 
|  | s->reloc_statement.output_offset | 
|  | = dot - current_os->bfd_section->vma; | 
|  | s->reloc_statement.output_section | 
|  | = current_os->bfd_section; | 
|  | size = bfd_get_reloc_size (s->reloc_statement.howto); | 
|  | dot += TO_ADDR (size); | 
|  | if (!(current_os->bfd_section->flags & SEC_FIXED_SIZE)) | 
|  | current_os->bfd_section->size | 
|  | = TO_SIZE (dot - current_os->bfd_section->vma); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | dot = lang_size_sections_1 (&s->wild_statement.children.head, | 
|  | current_os, fill, dot, relax, | 
|  | check_regions); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_object_symbols_statement_enum: | 
|  | link_info.create_object_symbols_section = current_os->bfd_section; | 
|  | current_os->bfd_section->flags |= SEC_KEEP; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_output_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_target_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_input_section_enum: | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | i = s->input_section.section; | 
|  | if (relax) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool again; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_relax_section (i->owner, i, &link_info, &again)) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: can't relax section: %E\n")); | 
|  | if (again) | 
|  | *relax = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | dot = size_input_section (prev, current_os, fill, &removed, dot); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_input_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_fill_statement_enum: | 
|  | s->fill_statement.output_section = current_os->bfd_section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | fill = s->fill_statement.fill; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_assignment_statement_enum: | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma newdot = dot; | 
|  | etree_type *tree = s->assignment_statement.exp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | expld.dataseg.relro = exp_seg_relro_none; | 
|  |  | 
|  | exp_fold_tree (tree, os, current_os->bfd_section, &newdot); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldlang_check_relro_region (s); | 
|  |  | 
|  | expld.dataseg.relro = exp_seg_relro_none; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This symbol may be relative to this section.  */ | 
|  | if ((tree->type.node_class == etree_provided | 
|  | || tree->type.node_class == etree_assign) | 
|  | && (tree->assign.dst [0] != '.' | 
|  | || tree->assign.dst [1] != '\0')) | 
|  | current_os->update_dot = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!current_os->ignored) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (current_os == abs_output_section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If we don't have an output section, then just adjust | 
|  | the default memory address.  */ | 
|  | lang_memory_region_lookup (DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION, | 
|  | false)->current = newdot; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (newdot != dot) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Insert a pad after this statement.  We can't | 
|  | put the pad before when relaxing, in case the | 
|  | assignment references dot.  */ | 
|  | insert_pad (&s->header.next, fill, TO_SIZE (newdot - dot), | 
|  | current_os->bfd_section, dot); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Don't neuter the pad below when relaxing.  */ | 
|  | s = s->header.next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If dot is advanced, this implies that the section | 
|  | should have space allocated to it, unless the | 
|  | user has explicitly stated that the section | 
|  | should not be allocated.  */ | 
|  | if (current_os->sectype != noalloc_section | 
|  | && (current_os->sectype != noload_section | 
|  | || (bfd_get_flavour (link_info.output_bfd) | 
|  | == bfd_target_elf_flavour))) | 
|  | current_os->bfd_section->flags |= SEC_ALLOC; | 
|  | } | 
|  | dot = newdot; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_padding_statement_enum: | 
|  | /* If this is the first time lang_size_sections is called, | 
|  | we won't have any padding statements.  If this is the | 
|  | second or later passes when relaxing, we should allow | 
|  | padding to shrink.  If padding is needed on this pass, it | 
|  | will be added back in.  */ | 
|  | s->padding_statement.size = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure output_offset is valid.  If relaxation shrinks | 
|  | the section and this pad isn't needed, it's possible to | 
|  | have output_offset larger than the final size of the | 
|  | section.  bfd_set_section_contents will complain even for | 
|  | a pad size of zero.  */ | 
|  | s->padding_statement.output_offset | 
|  | = dot - current_os->bfd_section->vma; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | dot = lang_size_sections_1 (&s->group_statement.children.head, | 
|  | current_os, fill, dot, relax, | 
|  | check_regions); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_insert_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We can only get here when relaxing is turned on.  */ | 
|  | case lang_address_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | FAIL (); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If an input section doesn't fit in the current output | 
|  | section, remove it from the list.  Handle the case where we | 
|  | have to remove an input_section statement here: there is a | 
|  | special case to remove the first element of the list.  */ | 
|  | if (link_info.non_contiguous_regions && removed) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If we removed the first element during the previous | 
|  | iteration, override the loop assignment of prev_s.  */ | 
|  | if (removed_prev_s) | 
|  | prev_s = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (prev_s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If there was a real previous input section, just skip | 
|  | the current one.  */ | 
|  | prev_s->header.next=s->header.next; | 
|  | s = prev_s; | 
|  | removed_prev_s = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Remove the first input section of the list.  */ | 
|  | *prev = s->header.next; | 
|  | removed_prev_s = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Move to next element, unless we removed the head of the | 
|  | list.  */ | 
|  | if (!removed_prev_s) | 
|  | prev = &s->header.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | prev = &s->header.next; | 
|  | removed_prev_s = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return dot; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Callback routine that is used in _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments. | 
|  | The BFD library has set NEW_SEGMENT to TRUE iff it thinks that | 
|  | CURRENT_SECTION and PREVIOUS_SECTION ought to be placed into different | 
|  | segments.  We are allowed an opportunity to override this decision.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool | 
|  | ldlang_override_segment_assignment (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | asection *current_section, | 
|  | asection *previous_section, | 
|  | bool new_segment) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *cur; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *prev; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The checks below are only necessary when the BFD library has decided | 
|  | that the two sections ought to be placed into the same segment.  */ | 
|  | if (new_segment) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Paranoia checks.  */ | 
|  | if (current_section == NULL || previous_section == NULL) | 
|  | return new_segment; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this flag is set, the target never wants code and non-code | 
|  | sections comingled in the same segment.  */ | 
|  | if (config.separate_code | 
|  | && ((current_section->flags ^ previous_section->flags) & SEC_CODE)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find the memory regions associated with the two sections. | 
|  | We call lang_output_section_find() here rather than scanning the list | 
|  | of output sections looking for a matching section pointer because if | 
|  | we have a large number of sections then a hash lookup is faster.  */ | 
|  | cur  = lang_output_section_find (current_section->name); | 
|  | prev = lang_output_section_find (previous_section->name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* More paranoia.  */ | 
|  | if (cur == NULL || prev == NULL) | 
|  | return new_segment; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If the regions are different then force the sections to live in | 
|  | different segments.  See the email thread starting at the following | 
|  | URL for the reasons why this is necessary: | 
|  | http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2007-02/msg00216.html  */ | 
|  | return cur->region != prev->region; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | one_lang_size_sections_pass (bool *relax, bool check_regions) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_iteration++; | 
|  | if (expld.phase != lang_mark_phase_enum) | 
|  | lang_sizing_iteration++; | 
|  | lang_size_sections_1 (&statement_list.head, abs_output_section, | 
|  | 0, 0, relax, check_regions); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | lang_size_segment (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If XXX_SEGMENT_ALIGN XXX_SEGMENT_END pair was seen, check whether | 
|  | a page could be saved in the data segment.  */ | 
|  | seg_align_type *seg = &expld.dataseg; | 
|  | bfd_vma first, last; | 
|  |  | 
|  | first = -seg->base & (seg->commonpagesize - 1); | 
|  | last = seg->end & (seg->commonpagesize - 1); | 
|  | if (first && last | 
|  | && ((seg->base & ~(seg->commonpagesize - 1)) | 
|  | != (seg->end & ~(seg->commonpagesize - 1))) | 
|  | && first + last <= seg->commonpagesize) | 
|  | { | 
|  | seg->phase = exp_seg_adjust; | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | seg->phase = exp_seg_done; | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bfd_vma | 
|  | lang_size_relro_segment_1 (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | seg_align_type *seg = &expld.dataseg; | 
|  | bfd_vma relro_end, desired_end; | 
|  | asection *sec; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Compute the expected PT_GNU_RELRO/PT_LOAD segment end.  */ | 
|  | relro_end = (seg->relro_end + seg->relropagesize - 1) & -seg->relropagesize; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Adjust by the offset arg of XXX_SEGMENT_RELRO_END.  */ | 
|  | desired_end = relro_end - seg->relro_offset; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For sections in the relro segment..  */ | 
|  | for (sec = link_info.output_bfd->section_last; sec; sec = sec->prev) | 
|  | if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 | 
|  | && sec->vma >= seg->base | 
|  | && sec->vma < seg->relro_end - seg->relro_offset) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Where do we want to put this section so that it ends as | 
|  | desired?  */ | 
|  | bfd_vma start, end, bump; | 
|  |  | 
|  | end = start = sec->vma; | 
|  | if (!IS_TBSS (sec)) | 
|  | end += TO_ADDR (sec->size); | 
|  | bump = desired_end - end; | 
|  | /* We'd like to increase START by BUMP, but we must heed | 
|  | alignment so the increase might be less than optimum.  */ | 
|  | start += bump; | 
|  | start &= ~(((bfd_vma) 1 << sec->alignment_power) - 1); | 
|  | /* This is now the desired end for the previous section.  */ | 
|  | desired_end = start; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | seg->phase = exp_seg_relro_adjust; | 
|  | ASSERT (desired_end >= seg->base); | 
|  | seg->base = desired_end; | 
|  | return relro_end; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | lang_size_relro_segment (bool *relax, bool check_regions) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool do_reset = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.relro && expld.dataseg.relro_end) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma data_initial_base = expld.dataseg.base; | 
|  | bfd_vma data_relro_end = lang_size_relro_segment_1 (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_reset_memory_regions (); | 
|  | one_lang_size_sections_pass (relax, check_regions); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Assignments to dot, or to output section address in a user | 
|  | script have increased padding over the original.  Revert.  */ | 
|  | if (expld.dataseg.relro_end > data_relro_end) | 
|  | { | 
|  | expld.dataseg.base = data_initial_base; | 
|  | do_reset = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (lang_size_segment ()) | 
|  | do_reset = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return do_reset; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_size_sections (bool *relax, bool check_regions) | 
|  | { | 
|  | expld.phase = lang_allocating_phase_enum; | 
|  | expld.dataseg.phase = exp_seg_none; | 
|  |  | 
|  | one_lang_size_sections_pass (relax, check_regions); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (expld.dataseg.phase != exp_seg_end_seen) | 
|  | expld.dataseg.phase = exp_seg_done; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (expld.dataseg.phase == exp_seg_end_seen) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool do_reset | 
|  | = lang_size_relro_segment (relax, check_regions); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (do_reset) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_reset_memory_regions (); | 
|  | one_lang_size_sections_pass (relax, check_regions); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.relro && expld.dataseg.relro_end) | 
|  | { | 
|  | link_info.relro_start = expld.dataseg.base; | 
|  | link_info.relro_end = expld.dataseg.relro_end; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_output_section_statement_type *current_section; | 
|  | static lang_assignment_statement_type *current_assign; | 
|  | static bool prefer_next_section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Worker function for lang_do_assignments.  Recursiveness goes here.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bfd_vma | 
|  | lang_do_assignments_1 (lang_statement_union_type *s, | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *current_os, | 
|  | fill_type *fill, | 
|  | bfd_vma dot, | 
|  | bool *found_end) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os = current_os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; s != NULL; s = s->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (s->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | dot = lang_do_assignments_1 (constructor_list.head, | 
|  | current_os, fill, dot, found_end); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma newdot; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os = &s->output_section_statement; | 
|  | os->after_end = *found_end; | 
|  | init_opb (os->bfd_section); | 
|  | newdot = dot; | 
|  | if (os->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!os->ignored && (os->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | current_section = os; | 
|  | prefer_next_section = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | newdot = os->bfd_section->vma; | 
|  | } | 
|  | newdot = lang_do_assignments_1 (os->children.head, | 
|  | os, os->fill, newdot, found_end); | 
|  | if (!os->ignored) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (os->bfd_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | newdot = os->bfd_section->vma; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size.  */ | 
|  | if (!IS_TBSS (os->bfd_section) | 
|  | || bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | newdot += TO_ADDR (os->bfd_section->size); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->update_dot_tree != NULL) | 
|  | exp_fold_tree (os->update_dot_tree, os, | 
|  | bfd_abs_section_ptr, &newdot); | 
|  | } | 
|  | dot = newdot; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  |  | 
|  | dot = lang_do_assignments_1 (s->wild_statement.children.head, | 
|  | current_os, fill, dot, found_end); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_object_symbols_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_output_statement_enum: | 
|  | case lang_target_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_data_statement_enum: | 
|  | exp_fold_tree (s->data_statement.exp, os, bfd_abs_section_ptr, &dot); | 
|  | if (expld.result.valid_p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | s->data_statement.value = expld.result.value; | 
|  | if (expld.result.section != NULL) | 
|  | s->data_statement.value += expld.result.section->vma; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (expld.phase == lang_final_phase_enum) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: invalid data statement\n")); | 
|  | { | 
|  | unsigned int size; | 
|  | switch (s->data_statement.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | case QUAD: | 
|  | case SQUAD: | 
|  | size = QUAD_SIZE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case LONG: | 
|  | size = LONG_SIZE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case SHORT: | 
|  | size = SHORT_SIZE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case BYTE: | 
|  | size = BYTE_SIZE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (size < TO_SIZE ((unsigned) 1)) | 
|  | size = TO_SIZE ((unsigned) 1); | 
|  | dot += TO_ADDR (size); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_reloc_statement_enum: | 
|  | exp_fold_tree (s->reloc_statement.addend_exp, os, | 
|  | bfd_abs_section_ptr, &dot); | 
|  | if (expld.result.valid_p) | 
|  | s->reloc_statement.addend_value = expld.result.value; | 
|  | else if (expld.phase == lang_final_phase_enum) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: invalid reloc statement\n")); | 
|  | dot += TO_ADDR (bfd_get_reloc_size (s->reloc_statement.howto)); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_input_section_enum: | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *in = s->input_section.section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((in->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0) | 
|  | dot += TO_ADDR (in->size); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_input_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_fill_statement_enum: | 
|  | fill = s->fill_statement.fill; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_assignment_statement_enum: | 
|  | current_assign = &s->assignment_statement; | 
|  | if (current_assign->exp->type.node_class != etree_assert) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *p = current_assign->exp->assign.dst; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (current_os == abs_output_section && p[0] == '.' && p[1] == 0) | 
|  | prefer_next_section = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (*p == '_') | 
|  | ++p; | 
|  | if (strcmp (p, "end") == 0) | 
|  | *found_end = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | exp_fold_tree (s->assignment_statement.exp, os, | 
|  | (current_os->bfd_section != NULL | 
|  | ? current_os->bfd_section : bfd_und_section_ptr), | 
|  | &dot); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_padding_statement_enum: | 
|  | dot += TO_ADDR (s->padding_statement.size); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | dot = lang_do_assignments_1 (s->group_statement.children.head, | 
|  | current_os, fill, dot, found_end); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_insert_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case lang_address_statement_enum: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | FAIL (); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return dot; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_do_assignments (lang_phase_type phase) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool found_end = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | current_section = NULL; | 
|  | prefer_next_section = false; | 
|  | expld.phase = phase; | 
|  | lang_statement_iteration++; | 
|  | lang_do_assignments_1 (statement_list.head, | 
|  | abs_output_section, NULL, 0, &found_end); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For an assignment statement outside of an output section statement, | 
|  | choose the best of neighbouring output sections to use for values | 
|  | of "dot".  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | asection * | 
|  | section_for_dot (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Assignments belong to the previous output section, unless there | 
|  | has been an assignment to "dot", in which case following | 
|  | assignments belong to the next output section.  (The assumption | 
|  | is that an assignment to "dot" is setting up the address for the | 
|  | next output section.)  Except that past the assignment to "_end" | 
|  | we always associate with the previous section.  This exception is | 
|  | for targets like SH that define an alloc .stack or other | 
|  | weirdness after non-alloc sections.  */ | 
|  | if (current_section == NULL || prefer_next_section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type *stmt; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (stmt = (lang_statement_union_type *) current_assign; | 
|  | stmt != NULL; | 
|  | stmt = stmt->header.next) | 
|  | if (stmt->header.type == lang_output_section_statement_enum) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os = stmt ? &stmt->output_section_statement : NULL; | 
|  | while (os != NULL | 
|  | && !os->after_end | 
|  | && (os->bfd_section == NULL | 
|  | || (os->bfd_section->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0 | 
|  | || bfd_section_removed_from_list (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | os->bfd_section))) | 
|  | os = os->next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (current_section == NULL || os == NULL || !os->after_end) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (os != NULL) | 
|  | s = os->bfd_section; | 
|  | else | 
|  | s = link_info.output_bfd->section_last; | 
|  | while (s != NULL | 
|  | && ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0 | 
|  | || (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)) | 
|  | s = s->prev; | 
|  | if (s != NULL) | 
|  | return s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return bfd_abs_section_ptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | s = current_section->bfd_section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The section may have been stripped.  */ | 
|  | while (s != NULL | 
|  | && ((s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0 | 
|  | || (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0 | 
|  | || (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0 | 
|  | || bfd_section_removed_from_list (link_info.output_bfd, s))) | 
|  | s = s->prev; | 
|  | if (s == NULL) | 
|  | s = link_info.output_bfd->sections; | 
|  | while (s != NULL | 
|  | && ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0 | 
|  | || (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)) | 
|  | s = s->next; | 
|  | if (s != NULL) | 
|  | return s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return bfd_abs_section_ptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Array of __start/__stop/.startof./.sizeof/ symbols.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bfd_link_hash_entry **start_stop_syms; | 
|  | static size_t start_stop_count = 0; | 
|  | static size_t start_stop_alloc = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Give start/stop SYMBOL for SEC a preliminary definition, and add it | 
|  | to start_stop_syms.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_define_start_stop (const char *symbol, asection *sec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h; | 
|  |  | 
|  | h = bfd_define_start_stop (link_info.output_bfd, &link_info, symbol, sec); | 
|  | if (h != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (start_stop_count == start_stop_alloc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | start_stop_alloc = 2 * start_stop_alloc + 10; | 
|  | start_stop_syms | 
|  | = xrealloc (start_stop_syms, | 
|  | start_stop_alloc * sizeof (*start_stop_syms)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | start_stop_syms[start_stop_count++] = h; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check for input sections whose names match references to | 
|  | __start_SECNAME or __stop_SECNAME symbols.  Give the symbols | 
|  | preliminary definitions.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_init_start_stop (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd *abfd; | 
|  | asection *s; | 
|  | char leading_char = bfd_get_symbol_leading_char (link_info.output_bfd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (abfd = link_info.input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link.next) | 
|  | for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *ps; | 
|  | const char *secname = s->name; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ps = secname; *ps != '\0'; ps++) | 
|  | if (!ISALNUM ((unsigned char) *ps) && *ps != '_') | 
|  | break; | 
|  | if (*ps == '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *symbol = (char *) xmalloc (10 + strlen (secname)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | symbol[0] = leading_char; | 
|  | sprintf (symbol + (leading_char != 0), "__start_%s", secname); | 
|  | lang_define_start_stop (symbol, s); | 
|  |  | 
|  | symbol[1] = leading_char; | 
|  | memcpy (symbol + 1 + (leading_char != 0), "__stop", 6); | 
|  | lang_define_start_stop (symbol + 1, s); | 
|  |  | 
|  | free (symbol); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Iterate over start_stop_syms.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | foreach_start_stop (void (*func) (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | size_t i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < start_stop_count; ++i) | 
|  | func (start_stop_syms[i]); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* __start and __stop symbols are only supposed to be defined by the | 
|  | linker for orphan sections, but we now extend that to sections that | 
|  | map to an output section of the same name.  The symbols were | 
|  | defined early for --gc-sections, before we mapped input to output | 
|  | sections, so undo those that don't satisfy this rule.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | undef_start_stop (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (h->ldscript_def) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (h->u.def.section->output_section == NULL | 
|  | || h->u.def.section->output_section->owner != link_info.output_bfd | 
|  | || strcmp (h->u.def.section->name, | 
|  | h->u.def.section->output_section->name) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | h->u.def.section->name); | 
|  | if (sec != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* When there are more than one input sections with the same | 
|  | section name, SECNAME, linker picks the first one to define | 
|  | __start_SECNAME and __stop_SECNAME symbols.  When the first | 
|  | input section is removed by comdat group, we need to check | 
|  | if there is still an output section with section name | 
|  | SECNAME.  */ | 
|  | asection *i; | 
|  | for (i = sec->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s) | 
|  | if (strcmp (h->u.def.section->name, i->name) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | h->u.def.section = i; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | h->type = bfd_link_hash_undefined; | 
|  | h->u.undef.abfd = NULL; | 
|  | if (is_elf_hash_table (link_info.hash)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct elf_backend_data *bed; | 
|  | struct elf_link_hash_entry *eh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h; | 
|  | unsigned int was_forced = eh->forced_local; | 
|  |  | 
|  | bed = get_elf_backend_data (link_info.output_bfd); | 
|  | (*bed->elf_backend_hide_symbol) (&link_info, eh, true); | 
|  | if (!eh->ref_regular_nonweak) | 
|  | h->type = bfd_link_hash_undefweak; | 
|  | eh->def_regular = 0; | 
|  | eh->forced_local = was_forced; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_undef_start_stop (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | foreach_start_stop (undef_start_stop); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check for output sections whose names match references to | 
|  | .startof.SECNAME or .sizeof.SECNAME symbols.  Give the symbols | 
|  | preliminary definitions.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_init_startof_sizeof (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (s = link_info.output_bfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *secname = s->name; | 
|  | char *symbol = (char *) xmalloc (10 + strlen (secname)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sprintf (symbol, ".startof.%s", secname); | 
|  | lang_define_start_stop (symbol, s); | 
|  |  | 
|  | memcpy (symbol + 1, ".size", 5); | 
|  | lang_define_start_stop (symbol + 1, s); | 
|  | free (symbol); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set .startof., .sizeof., __start and __stop symbols final values.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | set_start_stop (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (h->ldscript_def | 
|  | || h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (h->root.string[0] == '.') | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* .startof. or .sizeof. symbol. | 
|  | .startof. already has final value.  */ | 
|  | if (h->root.string[2] == 'i') | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* .sizeof.  */ | 
|  | h->u.def.value = TO_ADDR (h->u.def.section->size); | 
|  | h->u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* __start or __stop symbol.  */ | 
|  | int has_lead = bfd_get_symbol_leading_char (link_info.output_bfd) != 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | h->u.def.section = h->u.def.section->output_section; | 
|  | if (h->root.string[4 + has_lead] == 'o') | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* __stop_ */ | 
|  | h->u.def.value = TO_ADDR (h->u.def.section->size); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_finalize_start_stop (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | foreach_start_stop (set_start_stop); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_symbol_tweaks (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Give initial values for __start and __stop symbols, so that  ELF | 
|  | gc_sections will keep sections referenced by these symbols.  Must | 
|  | be done before lang_do_assignments.  */ | 
|  | if (config.build_constructors) | 
|  | lang_init_start_stop (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make __ehdr_start hidden, and set def_regular even though it is | 
|  | likely undefined at this stage.  For lang_check_relocs.  */ | 
|  | if (is_elf_hash_table (link_info.hash) | 
|  | && !bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) | 
|  | bfd_link_hash_lookup (link_info.hash, "__ehdr_start", | 
|  | false, false, true); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Only adjust the export class if the symbol was referenced | 
|  | and not defined, otherwise leave it alone.  */ | 
|  | if (h != NULL | 
|  | && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new | 
|  | || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined | 
|  | || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak | 
|  | || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct elf_backend_data *bed; | 
|  | bed = get_elf_backend_data (link_info.output_bfd); | 
|  | (*bed->elf_backend_hide_symbol) (&link_info, h, true); | 
|  | if (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_INTERNAL) | 
|  | h->other = (h->other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) | STV_HIDDEN; | 
|  | h->def_regular = 1; | 
|  | h->root.linker_def = 1; | 
|  | h->root.rel_from_abs = 1; | 
|  | elf_hash_table (&link_info)->hehdr_start = h; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_end (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h; | 
|  | bool warn; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) && !link_info.gc_sections) | 
|  | || bfd_link_dll (&link_info)) | 
|  | warn = entry_from_cmdline; | 
|  | else | 
|  | warn = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Force the user to specify a root when generating a relocatable with | 
|  | --gc-sections, unless --gc-keep-exported was also given.  */ | 
|  | if (bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) | 
|  | && link_info.gc_sections | 
|  | && !link_info.gc_keep_exported) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_sym_chain *sym; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (sym = link_info.gc_sym_list; sym != NULL; sym = sym->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (link_info.hash, sym->name, | 
|  | false, false, false); | 
|  | if (h != NULL | 
|  | && (h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined | 
|  | || h->type == bfd_link_hash_defweak) | 
|  | && !bfd_is_const_section (h->u.def.section)) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (!sym) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: --gc-sections requires a defined symbol root " | 
|  | "specified by -e or -u\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (entry_symbol.name == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* No entry has been specified.  Look for the default entry, but | 
|  | don't warn if we don't find it.  */ | 
|  | entry_symbol.name = entry_symbol_default; | 
|  | warn = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (link_info.hash, entry_symbol.name, | 
|  | false, false, true); | 
|  | if (h != NULL | 
|  | && (h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined | 
|  | || h->type == bfd_link_hash_defweak) | 
|  | && h->u.def.section->output_section != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma val; | 
|  |  | 
|  | val = (h->u.def.value | 
|  | + bfd_section_vma (h->u.def.section->output_section) | 
|  | + h->u.def.section->output_offset); | 
|  | if (!bfd_set_start_address (link_info.output_bfd, val)) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: %s: can't set start address\n"), entry_symbol.name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma val; | 
|  | const char *send; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We couldn't find the entry symbol.  Try parsing it as a | 
|  | number.  */ | 
|  | val = bfd_scan_vma (entry_symbol.name, &send, 0); | 
|  | if (*send == '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!bfd_set_start_address (link_info.output_bfd, val)) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: can't set start address\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* BZ 2004952: Only use the start of the entry section for executables.  */ | 
|  | else if bfd_link_executable (&link_info) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *ts; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Can't find the entry symbol, and it's not a number.  Use | 
|  | the first address in the text section.  */ | 
|  | ts = bfd_get_section_by_name (link_info.output_bfd, entry_section); | 
|  | if (ts != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (warn) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: cannot find entry symbol %s;" | 
|  | " defaulting to %V\n"), | 
|  | entry_symbol.name, | 
|  | bfd_section_vma (ts)); | 
|  | if (!bfd_set_start_address (link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | bfd_section_vma (ts))) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: can't set start address\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (warn) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: cannot find entry symbol %s;" | 
|  | " not setting start address\n"), | 
|  | entry_symbol.name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (warn) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: cannot find entry symbol %s;" | 
|  | " not setting start address\n"), | 
|  | entry_symbol.name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is a small function used when we want to ignore errors from | 
|  | BFD.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | ignore_bfd_errors (const char *fmt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | va_list ap ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Don't do anything.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check that the architecture of all the input files is compatible | 
|  | with the output file.  Also call the backend to let it do any | 
|  | other checking that is needed.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_check (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *file; | 
|  | bfd *input_bfd; | 
|  | const bfd_arch_info_type *compatible; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (file = (void *) file_chain.head; | 
|  | file != NULL; | 
|  | file = file->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | /* Don't check format of files claimed by plugin.  */ | 
|  | if (file->flags.claimed) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | #endif /* BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS */ | 
|  | input_bfd = file->the_bfd; | 
|  | compatible | 
|  | = bfd_arch_get_compatible (input_bfd, link_info.output_bfd, | 
|  | command_line.accept_unknown_input_arch); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* In general it is not possible to perform a relocatable | 
|  | link between differing object formats when the input | 
|  | file has relocations, because the relocations in the | 
|  | input format may not have equivalent representations in | 
|  | the output format (and besides BFD does not translate | 
|  | relocs for other link purposes than a final link).  */ | 
|  | if (!file->flags.just_syms | 
|  | && (bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) | 
|  | || link_info.emitrelocations) | 
|  | && (compatible == NULL | 
|  | || (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) | 
|  | != bfd_get_flavour (link_info.output_bfd))) | 
|  | && (bfd_get_file_flags (input_bfd) & HAS_RELOC) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: relocatable linking with relocations from" | 
|  | " format %s (%pB) to format %s (%pB) is not supported\n"), | 
|  | bfd_get_target (input_bfd), input_bfd, | 
|  | bfd_get_target (link_info.output_bfd), link_info.output_bfd); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (compatible == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (command_line.warn_mismatch) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: %s architecture of input file `%pB'" | 
|  | " is incompatible with %s output\n"), | 
|  | bfd_printable_name (input_bfd), input_bfd, | 
|  | bfd_printable_name (link_info.output_bfd)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If the input bfd has no contents, it shouldn't set the | 
|  | private data of the output bfd.  */ | 
|  | else if (!file->flags.just_syms | 
|  | && ((input_bfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0 | 
|  | || bfd_count_sections (input_bfd) != 0)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_error_handler_type pfn = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we aren't supposed to warn about mismatched input | 
|  | files, temporarily set the BFD error handler to a | 
|  | function which will do nothing.  We still want to call | 
|  | bfd_merge_private_bfd_data, since it may set up | 
|  | information which is needed in the output file.  */ | 
|  | if (!command_line.warn_mismatch) | 
|  | pfn = bfd_set_error_handler (ignore_bfd_errors); | 
|  | if (!bfd_merge_private_bfd_data (input_bfd, &link_info)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (command_line.warn_mismatch) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: failed to merge target specific data" | 
|  | " of file %pB\n"), input_bfd); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (!command_line.warn_mismatch) | 
|  | bfd_set_error_handler (pfn); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look through all the global common symbols and attach them to the | 
|  | correct section.  The -sort-common command line switch may be used | 
|  | to roughly sort the entries by alignment.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_common (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (link_info.inhibit_common_definition) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | if (bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) | 
|  | && !command_line.force_common_definition) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!config.sort_common) | 
|  | bfd_link_hash_traverse (link_info.hash, lang_one_common, NULL); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | unsigned int power; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.sort_common == sort_descending) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (power = 4; power > 0; power--) | 
|  | bfd_link_hash_traverse (link_info.hash, lang_one_common, &power); | 
|  |  | 
|  | power = 0; | 
|  | bfd_link_hash_traverse (link_info.hash, lang_one_common, &power); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (power = 0; power <= 4; power++) | 
|  | bfd_link_hash_traverse (link_info.hash, lang_one_common, &power); | 
|  |  | 
|  | power = (unsigned int) -1; | 
|  | bfd_link_hash_traverse (link_info.hash, lang_one_common, &power); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Place one common symbol in the correct section.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | lang_one_common (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h, void *info) | 
|  | { | 
|  | unsigned int power_of_two; | 
|  | bfd_vma size; | 
|  | asection *section; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_common) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | size = h->u.c.size; | 
|  | power_of_two = h->u.c.p->alignment_power; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.sort_common == sort_descending | 
|  | && power_of_two < *(unsigned int *) info) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | else if (config.sort_common == sort_ascending | 
|  | && power_of_two > *(unsigned int *) info) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | section = h->u.c.p->section; | 
|  | if (!bfd_define_common_symbol (link_info.output_bfd, &link_info, h)) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: could not define common symbol `%pT': %E\n"), | 
|  | h->root.string); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.map_file != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | static bool header_printed; | 
|  | int len; | 
|  | char *name; | 
|  | char buf[32]; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!header_printed) | 
|  | { | 
|  | minfo (_("\nAllocating common symbols\n")); | 
|  | minfo (_("Common symbol       size              file\n\n")); | 
|  | header_printed = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | name = bfd_demangle (link_info.output_bfd, h->root.string, | 
|  | DMGL_ANSI | DMGL_PARAMS); | 
|  | if (name == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | minfo ("%s", h->root.string); | 
|  | len = strlen (h->root.string); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | minfo ("%s", name); | 
|  | len = strlen (name); | 
|  | free (name); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (len >= 19) | 
|  | { | 
|  | print_nl (); | 
|  | len = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | sprintf (buf, "%" PRIx64, (uint64_t) size); | 
|  | fprintf (config.map_file, "%*s0x%-16s", 20 - len, "", buf); | 
|  |  | 
|  | minfo ("%pB\n", section->owner); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Handle a single orphan section S, placing the orphan into an appropriate | 
|  | output section.  The effects of the --orphan-handling command line | 
|  | option are handled here.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | ldlang_place_orphan (asection *s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (config.orphan_handling == orphan_handling_discard) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  | os = lang_output_section_statement_lookup (DISCARD_SECTION_NAME, 0, 1); | 
|  | if (os->addr_tree == NULL | 
|  | && (bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) | 
|  | || (s->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_ALLOC)) == 0)) | 
|  | os->addr_tree = exp_intop (0); | 
|  | lang_add_section (&os->children, s, NULL, NULL, os); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  | const char *name = s->name; | 
|  | int constraint = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.orphan_handling == orphan_handling_error) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: error: unplaced orphan section `%pA' from `%pB'\n"), | 
|  | s, s->owner); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.unique_orphan_sections || unique_section_p (s, NULL)) | 
|  | constraint = SPECIAL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os = ldemul_place_orphan (s, name, constraint); | 
|  | if (os == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | os = lang_output_section_statement_lookup (name, constraint, 1); | 
|  | if (os->addr_tree == NULL | 
|  | && (bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) | 
|  | || (s->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_ALLOC)) == 0)) | 
|  | os->addr_tree = exp_intop (0); | 
|  | lang_add_section (&os->children, s, NULL, NULL, os); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.orphan_handling == orphan_handling_warn) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: orphan section `%pA' from `%pB' being " | 
|  | "placed in section `%s'\n"), | 
|  | s, s->owner, os->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Run through the input files and ensure that every input section has | 
|  | somewhere to go.  If one is found without a destination then create | 
|  | an input request and place it into the statement tree.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_place_orphans (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (s = file->the_bfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (s->output_section == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This section of the file is not attached, root | 
|  | around for a sensible place for it to go.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (file->flags.just_syms) | 
|  | bfd_link_just_syms (file->the_bfd, s, &link_info); | 
|  | else if (lang_discard_section_p (s)) | 
|  | s->output_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr; | 
|  | else if (strcmp (s->name, "COMMON") == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* This is a lonely common section which must have | 
|  | come from an archive.  We attach to the section | 
|  | with the wildcard.  */ | 
|  | if (!bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info) | 
|  | || command_line.force_common_definition) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (default_common_section == NULL) | 
|  | default_common_section | 
|  | = lang_output_section_statement_lookup (".bss", 0, 1); | 
|  | lang_add_section (&default_common_section->children, s, | 
|  | NULL, NULL, default_common_section); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | ldlang_place_orphan (s); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_set_flags (lang_memory_region_type *ptr, const char *flags, int invert) | 
|  | { | 
|  | flagword *ptr_flags; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ptr_flags = invert ? &ptr->not_flags : &ptr->flags; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (*flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (*flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* PR 17900: An exclamation mark in the attributes reverses | 
|  | the sense of any of the attributes that follow.  */ | 
|  | case '!': | 
|  | invert = !invert; | 
|  | ptr_flags = invert ? &ptr->not_flags : &ptr->flags; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case 'A': case 'a': | 
|  | *ptr_flags |= SEC_ALLOC; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case 'R': case 'r': | 
|  | *ptr_flags |= SEC_READONLY; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case 'W': case 'w': | 
|  | *ptr_flags |= SEC_DATA; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case 'X': case 'x': | 
|  | *ptr_flags |= SEC_CODE; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case 'L': case 'l': | 
|  | case 'I': case 'i': | 
|  | *ptr_flags |= SEC_LOAD; | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: invalid character %c (%d) in flags\n"), | 
|  | *flags, *flags); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | flags++; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Call a function on each real input file.  This function will be | 
|  | called on an archive, but not on the elements.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_for_each_input_file (void (*func) (lang_input_statement_type *)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *f; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (f = (void *) input_file_chain.head; | 
|  | f != NULL; | 
|  | f = f->next_real_file) | 
|  | if (f->flags.real) | 
|  | func (f); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Call a function on each real file.  The function will be called on | 
|  | all the elements of an archive which are included in the link, but | 
|  | will not be called on the archive file itself.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_for_each_file (void (*func) (lang_input_statement_type *)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (f) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (f->flags.real) | 
|  | func (f); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | ldlang_add_file (lang_input_statement_type *entry) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_append (&file_chain, entry, &entry->next); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The BFD linker needs to have a list of all input BFDs involved in | 
|  | a link.  */ | 
|  | ASSERT (link_info.input_bfds_tail != &entry->the_bfd->link.next | 
|  | && entry->the_bfd->link.next == NULL); | 
|  | ASSERT (entry->the_bfd != link_info.output_bfd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | *link_info.input_bfds_tail = entry->the_bfd; | 
|  | link_info.input_bfds_tail = &entry->the_bfd->link.next; | 
|  | bfd_set_usrdata (entry->the_bfd, entry); | 
|  | bfd_set_gp_size (entry->the_bfd, g_switch_value); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look through the sections and check for any which should not be | 
|  | included in the link.  We need to do this now, so that we can | 
|  | notice when the backend linker tries to report multiple | 
|  | definition errors for symbols which are in sections we aren't | 
|  | going to link.  FIXME: It might be better to entirely ignore | 
|  | symbols which are defined in sections which are going to be | 
|  | discarded.  This would require modifying the backend linker for | 
|  | each backend which might set the SEC_LINK_ONCE flag.  If we do | 
|  | this, we should probably handle SEC_EXCLUDE in the same way.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | bfd_map_over_sections (entry->the_bfd, section_already_linked, entry); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_output (const char *name, int from_script) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Make -o on command line override OUTPUT in script.  */ | 
|  | if (!had_output_filename || !from_script) | 
|  | { | 
|  | output_filename = name; | 
|  | had_output_filename = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type * | 
|  | lang_enter_output_section_statement (const char *output_section_statement_name, | 
|  | etree_type *address_exp, | 
|  | enum section_type sectype, | 
|  | etree_type *sectype_value, | 
|  | etree_type *align, | 
|  | etree_type *subalign, | 
|  | etree_type *ebase, | 
|  | int constraint, | 
|  | int align_with_input) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os = lang_output_section_statement_lookup (output_section_statement_name, | 
|  | constraint, | 
|  | in_section_ordering ? 0 : 2); | 
|  | if (os == NULL) /* && in_section_ordering */ | 
|  | fatal (_("%P:%pS: error: output section '%s' must already exist\n"), | 
|  | NULL, output_section_statement_name); | 
|  | current_section = os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make next things chain into subchain of this.  */ | 
|  | push_stat_ptr (in_section_ordering ? &os->sort_children : &os->children); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (in_section_ordering) | 
|  | return os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->addr_tree == NULL) | 
|  | os->addr_tree = address_exp; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os->sectype = sectype; | 
|  | if (sectype == type_section || sectype == typed_readonly_section) | 
|  | os->sectype_value = sectype_value; | 
|  | else if (sectype == noload_section) | 
|  | os->flags = SEC_NEVER_LOAD; | 
|  | else | 
|  | os->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS; | 
|  | os->block_value = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os->align_lma_with_input = align_with_input == ALIGN_WITH_INPUT; | 
|  | if (os->align_lma_with_input && align != NULL) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P:%pS: error: align with input and explicit align specified\n"), | 
|  | NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | os->subsection_alignment = subalign; | 
|  | os->section_alignment = align; | 
|  |  | 
|  | os->load_base = ebase; | 
|  | return os; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_final (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_statement_type *new_stmt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_stmt = new_stat (lang_output_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  | new_stmt->name = output_filename; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Reset the current counters in the regions.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_reset_memory_regions (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *p = lang_memory_region_list; | 
|  | asection *o; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (p = lang_memory_region_list; p != NULL; p = p->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | p->current = p->origin; | 
|  | p->last_os = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (os = (void *) lang_os_list.head; | 
|  | os != NULL; | 
|  | os = os->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | os->processed_vma = false; | 
|  | os->processed_lma = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (o = link_info.output_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Save the last size for possible use by bfd_relax_section.  */ | 
|  | o->rawsize = o->size; | 
|  | if (!(o->flags & SEC_FIXED_SIZE)) | 
|  | o->size = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Worker for lang_gc_sections_1.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | gc_section_callback (lang_wild_statement_type *ptr, | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | asection *section, | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If the wild pattern was marked KEEP, the member sections | 
|  | should be as well.  */ | 
|  | if (ptr->keep_sections) | 
|  | section->flags |= SEC_KEEP; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Iterate over sections marking them against GC.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_gc_sections_1 (lang_statement_union_type *s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; s != NULL; s = s->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (s->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | walk_wild (&s->wild_statement, gc_section_callback, NULL); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | lang_gc_sections_1 (constructor_list.head); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | lang_gc_sections_1 (s->output_section_statement.children.head); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | lang_gc_sections_1 (s->group_statement.children.head); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_gc_sections (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Keep all sections so marked in the link script.  */ | 
|  | lang_gc_sections_1 (statement_list.head); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* SEC_EXCLUDE is ignored when doing a relocatable link, except in | 
|  | the special case of .stabstr debug info.  (See bfd/stabs.c) | 
|  | Twiddle the flag here, to simplify later linker code.  */ | 
|  | if (bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (f) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *sec; | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | if (f->flags.claimed) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | for (sec = f->the_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next) | 
|  | if ((sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) == 0 | 
|  | || strcmp (sec->name, ".stabstr") != 0) | 
|  | sec->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.gc_sections) | 
|  | bfd_gc_sections (link_info.output_bfd, &link_info); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Worker for lang_find_relro_sections_1.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | find_relro_section_callback (lang_wild_statement_type *ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | asection *section, | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, | 
|  | void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Discarded, excluded and ignored sections effectively have zero | 
|  | size.  */ | 
|  | if (section->output_section != NULL | 
|  | && section->output_section->owner == link_info.output_bfd | 
|  | && (section->output_section->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 | 
|  | && !IGNORE_SECTION (section) | 
|  | && section->size != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool *has_relro_section = (bool *) data; | 
|  | *has_relro_section = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Iterate over sections for relro sections.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_find_relro_sections_1 (lang_statement_union_type *s, | 
|  | bool *has_relro_section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (*has_relro_section) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; s != NULL; s = s->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (s == expld.dataseg.relro_end_stat) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (s->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | walk_wild (&s->wild_statement, | 
|  | find_relro_section_callback, | 
|  | has_relro_section); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_constructors_statement_enum: | 
|  | lang_find_relro_sections_1 (constructor_list.head, | 
|  | has_relro_section); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | lang_find_relro_sections_1 (s->output_section_statement.children.head, | 
|  | has_relro_section); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | lang_find_relro_sections_1 (s->group_statement.children.head, | 
|  | has_relro_section); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_find_relro_sections (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool has_relro_section = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check all sections in the link script.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_find_relro_sections_1 (expld.dataseg.relro_start_stat, | 
|  | &has_relro_section); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!has_relro_section) | 
|  | link_info.relro = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Relax all sections until bfd_relax_section gives up.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_relax_sections (bool need_layout) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* NB: Also enable relaxation to layout sections for DT_RELR.  */ | 
|  | if (RELAXATION_ENABLED || link_info.enable_dt_relr) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We may need more than one relaxation pass.  */ | 
|  | int i = link_info.relax_pass; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The backend can use it to determine the current pass.  */ | 
|  | link_info.relax_pass = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (i--) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Keep relaxing until bfd_relax_section gives up.  */ | 
|  | bool relax_again; | 
|  |  | 
|  | link_info.relax_trip = -1; | 
|  | do | 
|  | { | 
|  | link_info.relax_trip++; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Note: pe-dll.c does something like this also.  If you find | 
|  | you need to change this code, you probably need to change | 
|  | pe-dll.c also.  DJ  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do all the assignments with our current guesses as to | 
|  | section sizes.  */ | 
|  | lang_do_assignments (lang_assigning_phase_enum); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We must do this after lang_do_assignments, because it uses | 
|  | size.  */ | 
|  | lang_reset_memory_regions (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Perform another relax pass - this time we know where the | 
|  | globals are, so can make a better guess.  */ | 
|  | relax_again = false; | 
|  | lang_size_sections (&relax_again, false); | 
|  | } | 
|  | while (relax_again); | 
|  |  | 
|  | link_info.relax_pass++; | 
|  | } | 
|  | need_layout = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (need_layout) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Final extra sizing to report errors.  */ | 
|  | lang_do_assignments (lang_assigning_phase_enum); | 
|  | lang_reset_memory_regions (); | 
|  | lang_size_sections (NULL, true); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | /* Find the insert point for the plugin's replacement files.  We | 
|  | place them after the first claimed real object file, or if the | 
|  | first claimed object is an archive member, after the last real | 
|  | object file immediately preceding the archive.  In the event | 
|  | no objects have been claimed at all, we return the first dummy | 
|  | object file on the list as the insert point; that works, but | 
|  | the callee must be careful when relinking the file_chain as it | 
|  | is not actually on that chain, only the statement_list and the | 
|  | input_file list; in that case, the replacement files must be | 
|  | inserted at the head of the file_chain.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_input_statement_type * | 
|  | find_replacements_insert_point (bool *before) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *claim1, *lastobject; | 
|  | lastobject = (void *) input_file_chain.head; | 
|  | for (claim1 = (void *) file_chain.head; | 
|  | claim1 != NULL; | 
|  | claim1 = claim1->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (claim1->flags.claimed) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *before = claim1->flags.claim_archive; | 
|  | return claim1->flags.claim_archive ? lastobject : claim1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Update lastobject if this is a real object file.  */ | 
|  | if (claim1->the_bfd != NULL && claim1->the_bfd->my_archive == NULL) | 
|  | lastobject = claim1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* No files were claimed by the plugin.  Choose the last object | 
|  | file found on the list (maybe the first, dummy entry) as the | 
|  | insert point.  */ | 
|  | *before = false; | 
|  | return lastobject; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find where to insert ADD, an archive element or shared library | 
|  | added during a rescan.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_input_statement_type ** | 
|  | find_rescan_insertion (lang_input_statement_type *add) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd *add_bfd = add->the_bfd; | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *f; | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *last_loaded = NULL; | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *before = NULL; | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type **iter = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (add_bfd->my_archive != NULL) | 
|  | add_bfd = add_bfd->my_archive; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* First look through the input file chain, to find an object file | 
|  | before the one we've rescanned.  Normal object files always | 
|  | appear on both the input file chain and the file chain, so this | 
|  | lets us get quickly to somewhere near the correct place on the | 
|  | file chain if it is full of archive elements.  Archives don't | 
|  | appear on the file chain, but if an element has been extracted | 
|  | then their input_statement->next points at it.  */ | 
|  | for (f = (void *) input_file_chain.head; | 
|  | f != NULL; | 
|  | f = f->next_real_file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (f->the_bfd == add_bfd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | before = last_loaded; | 
|  | if (f->next != NULL) | 
|  | return &f->next->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (f->the_bfd != NULL && f->next != NULL) | 
|  | last_loaded = f; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (iter = before ? &before->next : &file_chain.head->input_statement.next; | 
|  | *iter != NULL; | 
|  | iter = &(*iter)->next) | 
|  | if (!(*iter)->flags.claim_archive | 
|  | && (*iter)->the_bfd->my_archive == NULL) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return iter; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Detach new nodes added to DESTLIST since the time ORIGLIST | 
|  | was taken as a copy of it and leave them in ORIGLIST.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_list_remove_tail (lang_statement_list_type *destlist, | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type *origlist) | 
|  | { | 
|  | union lang_statement_union **savetail; | 
|  | /* Check that ORIGLIST really is an earlier state of DESTLIST.  */ | 
|  | ASSERT (origlist->head == destlist->head); | 
|  | savetail = origlist->tail; | 
|  | origlist->head = *(savetail); | 
|  | origlist->tail = destlist->tail; | 
|  | destlist->tail = savetail; | 
|  | *savetail = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static lang_statement_union_type ** | 
|  | find_next_input_statement (lang_statement_union_type **s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for ( ; *s; s = &(*s)->header.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **t; | 
|  | switch ((*s)->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case lang_input_statement_enum: | 
|  | return s; | 
|  | case lang_wild_statement_enum: | 
|  | t = &(*s)->wild_statement.children.head; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_group_statement_enum: | 
|  | t = &(*s)->group_statement.children.head; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lang_output_section_statement_enum: | 
|  | t = &(*s)->output_section_statement.children.head; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | t = find_next_input_statement (t); | 
|  | if (*t) | 
|  | return t; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return s; | 
|  | } | 
|  | #endif /* BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Insert SRCLIST into DESTLIST after given element by chaining | 
|  | on FIELD as the next-pointer.  (Counterintuitively does not need | 
|  | a pointer to the actual after-node itself, just its chain field.)  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_list_insert_after (lang_statement_list_type *destlist, | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type *srclist, | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **field) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *(srclist->tail) = *field; | 
|  | *field = srclist->head; | 
|  | if (destlist->tail == field) | 
|  | destlist->tail = srclist->tail; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add NAME to the list of garbage collection entry points.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_gc_name (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_sym_chain *sym; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (name == NULL) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | sym = stat_alloc (sizeof (*sym)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | sym->next = link_info.gc_sym_list; | 
|  | sym->name = name; | 
|  | link_info.gc_sym_list = sym; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check relocations.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_check_relocs (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (link_info.check_relocs_after_open_input) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd *abfd; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (abfd = link_info.input_bfds; | 
|  | abfd != (bfd *) NULL; abfd = abfd->link.next) | 
|  | if (!bfd_link_check_relocs (abfd, &link_info)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* No object output, fail return.  */ | 
|  | config.make_executable = false; | 
|  | /* Note: we do not abort the loop, but rather | 
|  | continue the scan in case there are other | 
|  | bad relocations to report.  */ | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look through all output sections looking for places where we can | 
|  | propagate forward the lma region.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_propagate_lma_regions (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (os = (void *) lang_os_list.head; | 
|  | os != NULL; | 
|  | os = os->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (os->prev != NULL | 
|  | && os->lma_region == NULL | 
|  | && os->load_base == NULL | 
|  | && os->addr_tree == NULL | 
|  | && os->region == os->prev->region) | 
|  | os->lma_region = os->prev->lma_region; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | warn_non_contiguous_discards (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if ((file->the_bfd->flags & (BFD_LINKER_CREATED | DYNAMIC)) != 0 | 
|  | || file->flags.just_syms) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (asection *s = file->the_bfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) | 
|  | if (s->output_section == NULL | 
|  | && (s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0) | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: warning: --enable-non-contiguous-regions " | 
|  | "discards section `%pA' from `%pB'\n"), | 
|  | s, file->the_bfd); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | reset_one_wild (lang_statement_union_type *statement) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (statement->header.type == lang_wild_statement_enum) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_wild_statement_type *stmt = &statement->wild_statement; | 
|  | lang_list_init (&stmt->matching_sections); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | reset_resolved_wilds (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_for_each_statement (reset_one_wild); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For each output section statement, splice any entries on the | 
|  | sort_children list before the first wild statement on the children | 
|  | list.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_os_merge_sort_children (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  | for (os = (void *) lang_os_list.head; os != NULL; os = os->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (os->sort_children.head != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **where; | 
|  | for (where = &os->children.head; | 
|  | *where != NULL; | 
|  | where = &(*where)->header.next) | 
|  | if ((*where)->header.type == lang_wild_statement_enum) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | lang_list_insert_after (&os->children, &os->sort_children, where); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_process (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_os_merge_sort_children (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Finalize dynamic list.  */ | 
|  | if (link_info.dynamic_list) | 
|  | lang_finalize_version_expr_head (&link_info.dynamic_list->head); | 
|  |  | 
|  | current_target = default_target; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Open the output file.  */ | 
|  | lang_for_each_statement (ldlang_open_output); | 
|  | init_opb (NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_create_output_section_statements (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add to the hash table all undefineds on the command line.  */ | 
|  | lang_place_undefineds (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_section_already_linked_table_init ()) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: can not create hash table: %E\n")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A first pass through the memory regions ensures that if any region | 
|  | references a symbol for its origin or length then this symbol will be | 
|  | added to the symbol table.  Having these symbols in the symbol table | 
|  | means that when we call open_input_bfds PROVIDE statements will | 
|  | trigger to provide any needed symbols.  The regions origins and | 
|  | lengths are not assigned as a result of this call.  */ | 
|  | lang_do_memory_regions (false); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a bfd for each input file.  */ | 
|  | current_target = default_target; | 
|  | lang_statement_iteration++; | 
|  | open_input_bfds (statement_list.head, NULL, OPEN_BFD_NORMAL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now that open_input_bfds has processed assignments and provide | 
|  | statements we can give values to symbolic origin/length now.  */ | 
|  | lang_do_memory_regions (true); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_before_plugin_all_symbols_read (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | #if BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS | 
|  | if (link_info.lto_plugin_active) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type added; | 
|  | lang_statement_list_type files, inputfiles; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Now all files are read, let the plugin(s) decide if there | 
|  | are any more to be added to the link before we call the | 
|  | emulation's after_open hook.  We create a private list of | 
|  | input statements for this purpose, which we will eventually | 
|  | insert into the global statement list after the first claimed | 
|  | file.  */ | 
|  | added = *stat_ptr; | 
|  | /* We need to manipulate all three chains in synchrony.  */ | 
|  | files = file_chain; | 
|  | inputfiles = input_file_chain; | 
|  | if (plugin_call_all_symbols_read ()) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: %s: plugin reported error after all symbols read\n"), | 
|  | plugin_error_plugin ()); | 
|  | link_info.lto_all_symbols_read = true; | 
|  | /* Open any newly added files, updating the file chains.  */ | 
|  | plugin_undefs = link_info.hash->undefs_tail; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *last_os = NULL; | 
|  | if (lang_os_list.head != NULL) | 
|  | last_os = ((lang_output_section_statement_type *) | 
|  | ((char *) lang_os_list.tail | 
|  | - offsetof (lang_output_section_statement_type, next))); | 
|  | open_input_bfds (*added.tail, last_os, OPEN_BFD_NORMAL); | 
|  | if (plugin_undefs == link_info.hash->undefs_tail) | 
|  | plugin_undefs = NULL; | 
|  | /* Restore the global list pointer now they have all been added.  */ | 
|  | lang_list_remove_tail (stat_ptr, &added); | 
|  | /* And detach the fresh ends of the file lists.  */ | 
|  | lang_list_remove_tail (&file_chain, &files); | 
|  | lang_list_remove_tail (&input_file_chain, &inputfiles); | 
|  | /* Were any new files added?  */ | 
|  | if (added.head != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* If so, we will insert them into the statement list immediately | 
|  | after the first input file that was claimed by the plugin, | 
|  | unless that file was an archive in which case it is inserted | 
|  | immediately before.  */ | 
|  | bool before; | 
|  | lang_statement_union_type **prev; | 
|  | plugin_insert = find_replacements_insert_point (&before); | 
|  | /* If a plugin adds input files without having claimed any, we | 
|  | don't really have a good idea where to place them.  Just putting | 
|  | them at the start or end of the list is liable to leave them | 
|  | outside the crtbegin...crtend range.  */ | 
|  | ASSERT (plugin_insert != NULL); | 
|  | /* Splice the new statement list into the old one.  */ | 
|  | prev = &plugin_insert->header.next; | 
|  | if (before) | 
|  | { | 
|  | prev = find_next_input_statement (prev); | 
|  | if (*prev != (void *) plugin_insert->next_real_file) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We didn't find the expected input statement. | 
|  | Fall back to adding after plugin_insert.  */ | 
|  | prev = &plugin_insert->header.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | lang_list_insert_after (stat_ptr, &added, prev); | 
|  | /* Likewise for the file chains.  */ | 
|  | lang_list_insert_after (&input_file_chain, &inputfiles, | 
|  | (void *) &plugin_insert->next_real_file); | 
|  | /* We must be careful when relinking file_chain; we may need to | 
|  | insert the new files at the head of the list if the insert | 
|  | point chosen is the dummy first input file.  */ | 
|  | if (plugin_insert->filename) | 
|  | lang_list_insert_after (&file_chain, &files, | 
|  | (void *) &plugin_insert->next); | 
|  | else | 
|  | lang_list_insert_after (&file_chain, &files, &file_chain.head); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Rescan archives in case new undefined symbols have appeared.  */ | 
|  | files = file_chain; | 
|  | lang_statement_iteration++; | 
|  | open_input_bfds (statement_list.head, NULL, OPEN_BFD_RESCAN); | 
|  | lang_list_remove_tail (&file_chain, &files); | 
|  | while (files.head != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type **insert; | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type **iter, *temp; | 
|  | bfd *my_arch; | 
|  |  | 
|  | insert = find_rescan_insertion (&files.head->input_statement); | 
|  | /* All elements from an archive can be added at once.  */ | 
|  | iter = &files.head->input_statement.next; | 
|  | my_arch = files.head->input_statement.the_bfd->my_archive; | 
|  | if (my_arch != NULL) | 
|  | for (; *iter != NULL; iter = &(*iter)->next) | 
|  | if ((*iter)->the_bfd->my_archive != my_arch) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | temp = *insert; | 
|  | *insert = &files.head->input_statement; | 
|  | files.head = (lang_statement_union_type *) *iter; | 
|  | *iter = temp; | 
|  | if (file_chain.tail == (lang_statement_union_type **) insert) | 
|  | file_chain.tail = (lang_statement_union_type **) iter; | 
|  | if (my_arch != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *parent = bfd_usrdata (my_arch); | 
|  | if (parent != NULL) | 
|  | parent->next = (lang_input_statement_type *) | 
|  | ((char *) iter | 
|  | - offsetof (lang_input_statement_type, next)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | #endif /* BFD_SUPPORTS_PLUGINS */ | 
|  | if (bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Check if .gnu_object_only section should be created.  */ | 
|  | bfd *p; | 
|  | int object_type; | 
|  |  | 
|  | object_type = 0; | 
|  | for (p = link_info.input_bfds; p != (bfd *) NULL; p = p->link.next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | enum bfd_lto_object_type lto_type = bfd_get_lto_type (p); | 
|  | /* NB: Treat fat IR object as IR object here.  */ | 
|  | if (lto_type == lto_fat_ir_object) | 
|  | lto_type = lto_slim_ir_object; | 
|  | object_type |= 1 << lto_type; | 
|  | if ((object_type & (1 << lto_mixed_object)) != 0 | 
|  | || ((object_type | 
|  | & (1 << lto_non_ir_object | 
|  | | 1 << lto_slim_ir_object)) | 
|  | == (1 << lto_non_ir_object | 1 << lto_slim_ir_object))) | 
|  | { | 
|  | config.emit_gnu_object_only = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (verbose | 
|  | && (cmdline_object_only_file_list.head | 
|  | || cmdline_object_only_archive_list.head)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | info_msg (_("Object-only input files:\n ")); | 
|  | print_cmdline_list (cmdline_object_only_file_list.head); | 
|  | print_cmdline_list (cmdline_object_only_archive_list.head); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct bfd_sym_chain **sym = &link_info.gc_sym_list; | 
|  | while (*sym) | 
|  | sym = &(*sym)->next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | *sym = &entry_symbol; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (entry_symbol.name == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *sym = ldlang_undef_chain_list_head; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* entry_symbol is normally initialised by an ENTRY definition in the | 
|  | linker script or the -e command line option.  But if neither of | 
|  | these have been used, the target specific backend may still have | 
|  | provided an entry symbol via a call to lang_default_entry(). | 
|  | Unfortunately this value will not be processed until lang_end() | 
|  | is called, long after this function has finished.  So detect this | 
|  | case here and add the target's entry symbol to the list of starting | 
|  | points for garbage collection resolution.  */ | 
|  | lang_add_gc_name (entry_symbol_default); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_add_gc_name (link_info.init_function); | 
|  | lang_add_gc_name (link_info.fini_function); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_after_open (); | 
|  | if (config.map_file != NULL) | 
|  | lang_print_asneeded (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldlang_open_ctf (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bfd_section_already_linked_table_free (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure that we're not mixing architectures.  We call this | 
|  | after all the input files have been opened, but before we do any | 
|  | other processing, so that any operations merge_private_bfd_data | 
|  | does on the output file will be known during the rest of the | 
|  | link.  */ | 
|  | lang_check (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Handle .exports instead of a version script if we're told to do so.  */ | 
|  | if (command_line.version_exports_section) | 
|  | lang_do_version_exports_section (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Build all sets based on the information gathered from the input | 
|  | files.  */ | 
|  | ldctor_build_sets (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_symbol_tweaks (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* PR 13683: We must rerun the assignments prior to running garbage | 
|  | collection in order to make sure that all symbol aliases are resolved.  */ | 
|  | lang_do_assignments (lang_mark_phase_enum); | 
|  | expld.phase = lang_first_phase_enum; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Size up the common data.  */ | 
|  | lang_common (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (0) | 
|  | debug_prefix_tree (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | resolve_wilds (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove unreferenced sections if asked to.  */ | 
|  | lang_gc_sections (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_mark_undefineds (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check relocations.  */ | 
|  | lang_check_relocs (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_after_check_relocs (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* There might have been new sections created (e.g. as result of | 
|  | checking relocs to need a .got, or suchlike), so to properly order | 
|  | them into our lists of matching sections reset them here.  */ | 
|  | reset_resolved_wilds (); | 
|  | resolve_wilds (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update wild statements in case the user gave --sort-section. | 
|  | Note how the option might have come after the linker script and | 
|  | so couldn't have been set when the wild statements were created.  */ | 
|  | update_wild_statements (statement_list.head); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Run through the contours of the script and attach input sections | 
|  | to the correct output sections.  */ | 
|  | lang_statement_iteration++; | 
|  | map_input_to_output_sections (statement_list.head, NULL, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Start at the statement immediately after the special abs_section | 
|  | output statement, so that it isn't reordered.  */ | 
|  | process_insert_statements (&lang_os_list.head->header.next); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_before_place_orphans (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find any sections not attached explicitly and handle them.  */ | 
|  | lang_place_orphans (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *found; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Merge SEC_MERGE sections.  This has to be done after GC of | 
|  | sections, so that GCed sections are not merged, but before | 
|  | assigning dynamic symbols, since removing whole input sections | 
|  | is hard then.  */ | 
|  | if (!bfd_merge_sections (link_info.output_bfd, &link_info)) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: bfd_merge_sections failed: %E\n")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Look for a text section and set the readonly attribute in it.  */ | 
|  | found = bfd_get_section_by_name (link_info.output_bfd, ".text"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (found != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (config.text_read_only) | 
|  | found->flags |= SEC_READONLY; | 
|  | else | 
|  | found->flags &= ~SEC_READONLY; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Merge together CTF sections.  After this, only the symtab-dependent | 
|  | function and data object sections need adjustment.  */ | 
|  | lang_merge_ctf (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Emit the CTF, iff the emulation doesn't need to do late emission after | 
|  | examining things laid out late, like the strtab.  */ | 
|  | lang_write_ctf (0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Copy forward lma regions for output sections in same lma region.  */ | 
|  | lang_propagate_lma_regions (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Defining __start/__stop symbols early for --gc-sections to work | 
|  | around a glibc build problem can result in these symbols being | 
|  | defined when they should not be.  Fix them now.  */ | 
|  | if (config.build_constructors) | 
|  | lang_undef_start_stop (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Define .startof./.sizeof. symbols with preliminary values before | 
|  | dynamic symbols are created.  */ | 
|  | if (!bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | lang_init_startof_sizeof (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do anything special before sizing sections.  This is where ELF | 
|  | and other back-ends size dynamic sections.  */ | 
|  | ldemul_before_allocation (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* We must record the program headers before we try to fix the | 
|  | section positions, since they will affect SIZEOF_HEADERS.  */ | 
|  | lang_record_phdrs (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check relro sections.  */ | 
|  | if (link_info.relro && !bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | lang_find_relro_sections (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Size up the sections.  */ | 
|  | lang_size_sections (NULL, !RELAXATION_ENABLED); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See if anything special should be done now we know how big | 
|  | everything is.  This is where relaxation is done.  */ | 
|  | ldemul_after_allocation (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Fix any __start, __stop, .startof. or .sizeof. symbols.  */ | 
|  | lang_finalize_start_stop (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do all the assignments again, to report errors.  Assignment | 
|  | statements are processed multiple times, updating symbols; In | 
|  | open_input_bfds, lang_do_assignments, and lang_size_sections. | 
|  | Since lang_relax_sections calls lang_do_assignments, symbols are | 
|  | also updated in ldemul_after_allocation.  */ | 
|  | lang_do_assignments (lang_final_phase_enum); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_finish (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Convert absolute symbols to section relative.  */ | 
|  | ldexp_finalize_syms (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure that the section addresses make sense.  */ | 
|  | if (command_line.check_section_addresses) | 
|  | lang_check_section_addresses (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.non_contiguous_regions | 
|  | && link_info.non_contiguous_regions_warnings) | 
|  | warn_non_contiguous_discards (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check any required symbols are known.  */ | 
|  | ldlang_check_require_defined_symbols (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_end (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_version_string (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (! enable_linker_version) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const char * str = "GNU ld "; | 
|  | int len = strlen (str); | 
|  | int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0 ; i < len ; i++) | 
|  | lang_add_data (BYTE, exp_intop (str[i])); | 
|  |  | 
|  | str = BFD_VERSION_STRING; | 
|  | len = strlen (str); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0 ; i < len ; i++) | 
|  | lang_add_data (BYTE, exp_intop (str[i])); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_add_data (BYTE, exp_intop ('\0')); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* EXPORTED TO YACC */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_wild (struct wildcard_spec *filespec, | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *section_list, | 
|  | bool keep_sections) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct wildcard_list *curr, *next; | 
|  | lang_wild_statement_type *new_stmt; | 
|  | bool any_specs_sorted = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Reverse the list as the parser puts it back to front.  */ | 
|  | for (curr = section_list, section_list = NULL; | 
|  | curr != NULL; | 
|  | section_list = curr, curr = next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (curr->spec.sorted != none && curr->spec.sorted != by_none) | 
|  | any_specs_sorted = true; | 
|  | next = curr->next; | 
|  | curr->next = section_list; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (filespec != NULL && filespec->name != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (strcmp (filespec->name, "*") == 0) | 
|  | filespec->name = NULL; | 
|  | else if (!wildcardp (filespec->name)) | 
|  | lang_has_input_file = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_stmt = new_stat (lang_wild_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  | new_stmt->filename = NULL; | 
|  | new_stmt->filenames_sorted = false; | 
|  | new_stmt->any_specs_sorted = any_specs_sorted; | 
|  | new_stmt->section_flag_list = NULL; | 
|  | new_stmt->exclude_name_list = NULL; | 
|  | if (filespec != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | new_stmt->filename = filespec->name; | 
|  | new_stmt->filenames_sorted = (filespec->sorted == by_name || filespec->reversed); | 
|  | new_stmt->section_flag_list = filespec->section_flag_list; | 
|  | new_stmt->exclude_name_list = filespec->exclude_name_list; | 
|  | new_stmt->filenames_reversed = filespec->reversed; | 
|  | } | 
|  | new_stmt->section_list = section_list; | 
|  | new_stmt->keep_sections = keep_sections; | 
|  | lang_list_init (&new_stmt->children); | 
|  | lang_list_init (&new_stmt->matching_sections); | 
|  | analyze_walk_wild_section_handler (new_stmt); | 
|  | if (0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | printf ("wild %s(", new_stmt->filename ? new_stmt->filename : "*"); | 
|  | for (curr = new_stmt->section_list; curr; curr = curr->next) | 
|  | printf ("%s ", curr->spec.name ? curr->spec.name : "*"); | 
|  | printf (")\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_section_start (const char *name, etree_type *address, | 
|  | const segment_type *segment) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_address_statement_type *ad; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ad = new_stat (lang_address_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  | ad->section_name = name; | 
|  | ad->address = address; | 
|  | ad->segment = segment; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the start symbol to NAME.  CMDLINE is nonzero if this is called | 
|  | because of a -e argument on the command line, or zero if this is | 
|  | called by ENTRY in a linker script.  Command line arguments take | 
|  | precedence.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_entry (const char *name, bool cmdline) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (entry_symbol.name == NULL | 
|  | || cmdline | 
|  | || !entry_from_cmdline) | 
|  | { | 
|  | entry_symbol.name = name; | 
|  | entry_from_cmdline = cmdline; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the default start symbol to NAME.  .em files should use this, | 
|  | not lang_add_entry, to override the use of "start" if neither the | 
|  | linker script nor the command line specifies an entry point.  NAME | 
|  | must be permanently allocated.  */ | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_default_entry (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | entry_symbol_default = name; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_target (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_target_statement_type *new_stmt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_stmt = new_stat (lang_target_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  | new_stmt->target = name; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_map (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | while (*name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (*name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case 'F': | 
|  | map_option_f = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | name++; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_fill (fill_type *fill) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_fill_statement_type *new_stmt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_stmt = new_stat (lang_fill_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  | new_stmt->fill = fill; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_data (int type, union etree_union *exp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_data_statement_type *new_stmt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_stmt = new_stat (lang_data_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  | new_stmt->exp = exp; | 
|  | new_stmt->type = type; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_string (const char *s) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma  len = strlen (s); | 
|  | bfd_vma  i; | 
|  | bool     escape = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add byte expressions until end of string.  */ | 
|  | for (i = 0 ; i < len; i++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char c = *s++; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (escape) | 
|  | { | 
|  | switch (c) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | /* Ignore the escape.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case 'n': c = '\n'; break; | 
|  | case 'r': c = '\r'; break; | 
|  | case 't': c = '\t'; break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case '0': | 
|  | case '1': | 
|  | case '2': | 
|  | case '3': | 
|  | case '4': | 
|  | case '5': | 
|  | case '6': | 
|  | case '7': | 
|  | /* We have an octal number.  */ | 
|  | { | 
|  | unsigned int value = c - '0'; | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = *s; | 
|  | if ((c >= '0') && (c <= '7')) | 
|  | { | 
|  | value <<= 3; | 
|  | value += (c - '0'); | 
|  | i++; | 
|  | s++; | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = *s; | 
|  | if ((c >= '0') && (c <= '7')) | 
|  | { | 
|  | value <<= 3; | 
|  | value += (c - '0'); | 
|  | i++; | 
|  | s++; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (value > 0xff) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* octal: \777 is treated as '\077' + '7' */ | 
|  | value >>= 3; | 
|  | i--; | 
|  | s--; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = value; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_add_data (BYTE, exp_intop (c)); | 
|  | escape = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (c == '\\') | 
|  | escape = true; | 
|  | else | 
|  | lang_add_data (BYTE, exp_intop (c)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remeber to terminate the string.  */ | 
|  | lang_add_data (BYTE, exp_intop (0)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a new reloc statement.  RELOC is the BFD relocation type to | 
|  | generate.  HOWTO is the corresponding howto structure (we could | 
|  | look this up, but the caller has already done so).  SECTION is the | 
|  | section to generate a reloc against, or NAME is the name of the | 
|  | symbol to generate a reloc against.  Exactly one of SECTION and | 
|  | NAME must be NULL.  ADDEND is an expression for the addend.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_reloc (bfd_reloc_code_real_type reloc, | 
|  | reloc_howto_type *howto, | 
|  | asection *section, | 
|  | const char *name, | 
|  | union etree_union *addend) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_reloc_statement_type *p = new_stat (lang_reloc_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | p->reloc = reloc; | 
|  | p->howto = howto; | 
|  | p->section = section; | 
|  | p->name = name; | 
|  | p->addend_exp = addend; | 
|  |  | 
|  | p->addend_value = 0; | 
|  | p->output_section = NULL; | 
|  | p->output_offset = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_assignment_statement_type * | 
|  | lang_add_assignment (etree_type *exp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_assignment_statement_type *new_stmt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_stmt = new_stat (lang_assignment_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  | new_stmt->exp = exp; | 
|  | return new_stmt; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_attribute (enum statement_enum attribute) | 
|  | { | 
|  | new_statement (attribute, sizeof (lang_statement_header_type), stat_ptr); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_startup (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (first_file->filename != NULL) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: multiple STARTUP files\n")); | 
|  | first_file->filename = name; | 
|  | first_file->local_sym_name = name; | 
|  | first_file->flags.real = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_float (bool maybe) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_float_flag = maybe; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Work out the load- and run-time regions from a script statement, and | 
|  | store them in *LMA_REGION and *REGION respectively. | 
|  |  | 
|  | MEMSPEC is the name of the run-time region, or the value of | 
|  | DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION if the statement didn't specify one. | 
|  | LMA_MEMSPEC is the name of the load-time region, or null if the | 
|  | statement didn't specify one.HAVE_LMA_P is TRUE if the statement | 
|  | had an explicit load address. | 
|  |  | 
|  | It is an error to specify both a load region and a load address.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_get_regions (lang_memory_region_type **region, | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type **lma_region, | 
|  | const char *memspec, | 
|  | const char *lma_memspec, | 
|  | bool have_lma, | 
|  | bool have_vma) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *lma_region = lang_memory_region_lookup (lma_memspec, false); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If no runtime region or VMA has been specified, but the load region | 
|  | has been specified, then use the load region for the runtime region | 
|  | as well.  */ | 
|  | if (lma_memspec != NULL | 
|  | && !have_vma | 
|  | && strcmp (memspec, DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION) == 0) | 
|  | *region = *lma_region; | 
|  | else | 
|  | *region = lang_memory_region_lookup (memspec, false); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (have_lma && lma_memspec != 0) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P:%pS: section has both a load address and a load region\n"), | 
|  | NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_leave_output_section_statement (fill_type *fill, const char *memspec, | 
|  | lang_output_section_phdr_list *phdrs, | 
|  | const char *lma_memspec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | pop_stat_ptr (); | 
|  | if (in_section_ordering) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_get_regions (¤t_section->region, | 
|  | ¤t_section->lma_region, | 
|  | memspec, lma_memspec, | 
|  | current_section->load_base != NULL, | 
|  | current_section->addr_tree != NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | current_section->fill = fill; | 
|  | current_section->phdrs = phdrs; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set the output format type.  -oformat overrides scripts.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_output_format (const char *format, | 
|  | const char *big, | 
|  | const char *little, | 
|  | int from_script) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (output_target == NULL || !from_script) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (command_line.endian == ENDIAN_BIG | 
|  | && big != NULL) | 
|  | format = big; | 
|  | else if (command_line.endian == ENDIAN_LITTLE | 
|  | && little != NULL) | 
|  | format = little; | 
|  |  | 
|  | output_target = format; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_insert (const char *where, int is_before) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_insert_statement_type *new_stmt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_stmt = new_stat (lang_insert_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  | new_stmt->where = where; | 
|  | new_stmt->is_before = is_before; | 
|  | saved_script_handle = previous_script_handle; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Enter a group.  This creates a new lang_group_statement, and sets | 
|  | stat_ptr to build new statements within the group.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_enter_group (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_group_statement_type *g; | 
|  |  | 
|  | g = new_stat (lang_group_statement, stat_ptr); | 
|  | lang_list_init (&g->children); | 
|  | push_stat_ptr (&g->children); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Leave a group.  This just resets stat_ptr to start writing to the | 
|  | regular list of statements again.  Note that this will not work if | 
|  | groups can occur inside anything else which can adjust stat_ptr, | 
|  | but currently they can't.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_leave_group (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | pop_stat_ptr (); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add a new program header.  This is called for each entry in a PHDRS | 
|  | command in a linker script.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_new_phdr (const char *name, | 
|  | etree_type *type, | 
|  | bool filehdr, | 
|  | bool phdrs, | 
|  | etree_type *at, | 
|  | etree_type *flags) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct lang_phdr *n, **pp; | 
|  | bool hdrs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | n = stat_alloc (sizeof (struct lang_phdr)); | 
|  | n->next = NULL; | 
|  | n->name = name; | 
|  | n->type = exp_get_vma (type, NULL, 0, "program header type"); | 
|  | n->filehdr = filehdr; | 
|  | n->phdrs = phdrs; | 
|  | n->at = at; | 
|  | n->flags = flags; | 
|  |  | 
|  | hdrs = n->type == 1 && (phdrs || filehdr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (pp = &lang_phdr_list; *pp != NULL; pp = &(*pp)->next) | 
|  | if (hdrs | 
|  | && (*pp)->type == 1 | 
|  | && !((*pp)->filehdr || (*pp)->phdrs)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P:%pS: PHDRS and FILEHDR are not supported" | 
|  | " when prior PT_LOAD headers lack them\n"), NULL); | 
|  | hdrs = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | *pp = n; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Record the program header information in the output BFD.  FIXME: We | 
|  | should not be calling an ELF specific function here.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_record_phdrs (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | unsigned int alc; | 
|  | asection **secs; | 
|  | lang_output_section_phdr_list *last; | 
|  | struct lang_phdr *l; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | alc = 10; | 
|  | secs = (asection **) xmalloc (alc * sizeof (asection *)); | 
|  | last = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (l = lang_phdr_list; l != NULL; l = l->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | unsigned int c; | 
|  | flagword flags; | 
|  | bfd_vma at; | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = 0; | 
|  | for (os = (void *) lang_os_list.head; | 
|  | os != NULL; | 
|  | os = os->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_phdr_list *pl; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->constraint < 0) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | pl = os->phdrs; | 
|  | if (pl != NULL) | 
|  | last = pl; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (os->sectype == noload_section | 
|  | || os->bfd_section == NULL | 
|  | || (os->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Don't add orphans to PT_INTERP header.  */ | 
|  | if (l->type == PT_INTERP) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (last == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *tmp_os; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have not run across a section with a program | 
|  | header assigned to it yet, then scan forwards to find | 
|  | one.  This prevents inconsistencies in the linker's | 
|  | behaviour when a script has specified just a single | 
|  | header and there are sections in that script which are | 
|  | not assigned to it, and which occur before the first | 
|  | use of that header. See here for more details: | 
|  | http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2007-02/msg00291.html  */ | 
|  | for (tmp_os = os; tmp_os; tmp_os = tmp_os->next) | 
|  | if (tmp_os->phdrs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | last = tmp_os->phdrs; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (last == NULL) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: no sections assigned to phdrs\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  | pl = last; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; pl != NULL; pl = pl->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (strcmp (pl->name, l->name) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (c >= alc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | alc *= 2; | 
|  | secs = (asection **) xrealloc (secs, | 
|  | alc * sizeof (asection *)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | secs[c] = os->bfd_section; | 
|  | ++c; | 
|  | pl->used = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (l->flags == NULL) | 
|  | flags = 0; | 
|  | else | 
|  | flags = exp_get_vma (l->flags, NULL, 0, "phdr flags"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (l->at == NULL) | 
|  | at = 0; | 
|  | else | 
|  | at = exp_get_vma (l->at, NULL, 0, "phdr load address"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_record_phdr (link_info.output_bfd, l->type, | 
|  | l->flags != NULL, flags, l->at != NULL, | 
|  | at, l->filehdr, l->phdrs, c, secs)) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: bfd_record_phdr failed: %E\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | free (secs); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure all the phdr assignments succeeded.  */ | 
|  | for (os = (void *) lang_os_list.head; | 
|  | os != NULL; | 
|  | os = os->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_output_section_phdr_list *pl; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (os->constraint < 0 | 
|  | || os->bfd_section == NULL) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (pl = os->phdrs; | 
|  | pl != NULL; | 
|  | pl = pl->next) | 
|  | if (!pl->used && strcmp (pl->name, "NONE") != 0) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: section `%s' assigned to non-existent phdr `%s'\n"), | 
|  | os->name, pl->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Record a list of sections which may not be cross referenced.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_nocrossref (lang_nocrossref_type *l) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct lang_nocrossrefs *n; | 
|  |  | 
|  | n = stat_alloc (sizeof *n); | 
|  | n->next = nocrossref_list; | 
|  | n->list = l; | 
|  | n->onlyfirst = false; | 
|  | nocrossref_list = n; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set notice_all so that we get informed about all symbols.  */ | 
|  | link_info.notice_all = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Record a section that cannot be referenced from a list of sections.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_nocrossref_to (lang_nocrossref_type *l) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_add_nocrossref (l); | 
|  | nocrossref_list->onlyfirst = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Overlay handling.  We handle overlays with some static variables.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The overlay virtual address.  */ | 
|  | static etree_type *overlay_vma; | 
|  | /* And subsection alignment.  */ | 
|  | static etree_type *overlay_subalign; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* An expression for the maximum section size seen so far.  */ | 
|  | static etree_type *overlay_max; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* A list of all the sections in this overlay.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct overlay_list { | 
|  | struct overlay_list *next; | 
|  | lang_output_section_statement_type *os; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct overlay_list *overlay_list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Start handling an overlay.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_enter_overlay (etree_type *vma_expr, etree_type *subalign) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* The grammar should prevent nested overlays from occurring.  */ | 
|  | ASSERT (overlay_vma == NULL | 
|  | && overlay_subalign == NULL | 
|  | && overlay_max == NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | overlay_vma = vma_expr; | 
|  | overlay_subalign = subalign; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Start a section in an overlay.  We handle this by calling | 
|  | lang_enter_output_section_statement with the correct VMA. | 
|  | lang_leave_overlay sets up the LMA and memory regions.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_enter_overlay_section (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct overlay_list *n; | 
|  | etree_type *size; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_enter_output_section_statement (name, overlay_vma, overlay_section, | 
|  | 0, 0, overlay_subalign, 0, 0, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If this is the first section, then base the VMA of future | 
|  | sections on this one.  This will work correctly even if `.' is | 
|  | used in the addresses.  */ | 
|  | if (overlay_list == NULL) | 
|  | overlay_vma = exp_nameop (ADDR, name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remember the section.  */ | 
|  | n = (struct overlay_list *) xmalloc (sizeof *n); | 
|  | n->os = current_section; | 
|  | n->next = overlay_list; | 
|  | overlay_list = n; | 
|  |  | 
|  | size = exp_nameop (SIZEOF, name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Arrange to work out the maximum section end address.  */ | 
|  | if (overlay_max == NULL) | 
|  | overlay_max = size; | 
|  | else | 
|  | overlay_max = exp_binop (MAX_K, overlay_max, size); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Finish a section in an overlay.  There isn't any special to do | 
|  | here.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_leave_overlay_section (fill_type *fill, | 
|  | lang_output_section_phdr_list *phdrs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *name = current_section->name;; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* For now, assume that DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION is the run-time memory | 
|  | region and that no load-time region has been specified.  It doesn't | 
|  | really matter what we say here, since lang_leave_overlay will | 
|  | override it.  */ | 
|  | lang_leave_output_section_statement (fill, DEFAULT_MEMORY_REGION, phdrs, 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Define the magic symbols.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | char *clean = xmalloc (strlen (name) + 1); | 
|  | char *s2 = clean; | 
|  | for (const char *s1 = name; *s1 != '\0'; s1++) | 
|  | if (ISALNUM (*s1) || *s1 == '_') | 
|  | *s2++ = *s1; | 
|  | *s2 = '\0'; | 
|  |  | 
|  | char *buf = xasprintf ("__load_start_%s", clean); | 
|  | lang_add_assignment (exp_provide (buf, | 
|  | exp_nameop (LOADADDR, name), | 
|  | false)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | buf = xasprintf ("__load_stop_%s", clean); | 
|  | lang_add_assignment (exp_provide (buf, | 
|  | exp_binop ('+', | 
|  | exp_nameop (LOADADDR, name), | 
|  | exp_nameop (SIZEOF, name)), | 
|  | false)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | free (clean); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Finish an overlay.  If there are any overlay wide settings, this | 
|  | looks through all the sections in the overlay and sets them.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_leave_overlay (etree_type *lma_expr, | 
|  | int nocrossrefs, | 
|  | fill_type *fill, | 
|  | const char *memspec, | 
|  | lang_output_section_phdr_list *phdrs, | 
|  | const char *lma_memspec) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *region; | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *lma_region; | 
|  | struct overlay_list *l; | 
|  | lang_nocrossref_type *nocrossref; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_get_regions (®ion, &lma_region, | 
|  | memspec, lma_memspec, | 
|  | lma_expr != NULL, false); | 
|  |  | 
|  | nocrossref = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* After setting the size of the last section, set '.' to end of the | 
|  | overlay region.  */ | 
|  | if (overlay_list != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | overlay_list->os->update_dot = 1; | 
|  | overlay_list->os->update_dot_tree | 
|  | = exp_assign (".", exp_binop ('+', overlay_vma, overlay_max), false); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | l = overlay_list; | 
|  | while (l != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct overlay_list *next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (fill != NULL && l->os->fill == NULL) | 
|  | l->os->fill = fill; | 
|  |  | 
|  | l->os->region = region; | 
|  | l->os->lma_region = lma_region; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The first section has the load address specified in the | 
|  | OVERLAY statement.  The rest are worked out from that. | 
|  | The base address is not needed (and should be null) if | 
|  | an LMA region was specified.  */ | 
|  | if (l->next == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | l->os->load_base = lma_expr; | 
|  | l->os->sectype = first_overlay_section; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (phdrs != NULL && l->os->phdrs == NULL) | 
|  | l->os->phdrs = phdrs; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (nocrossrefs) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_nocrossref_type *nc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | nc = stat_alloc (sizeof *nc); | 
|  | nc->name = l->os->name; | 
|  | nc->next = nocrossref; | 
|  | nocrossref = nc; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | next = l->next; | 
|  | free (l); | 
|  | l = next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (nocrossref != NULL) | 
|  | lang_add_nocrossref (nocrossref); | 
|  |  | 
|  | overlay_vma = NULL; | 
|  | overlay_list = NULL; | 
|  | overlay_max = NULL; | 
|  | overlay_subalign = NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Version handling.  This is only useful for ELF.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If PREV is NULL, return first version pattern matching particular symbol. | 
|  | If PREV is non-NULL, return first version pattern matching particular | 
|  | symbol after PREV (previously returned by lang_vers_match).  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static struct bfd_elf_version_expr * | 
|  | lang_vers_match (struct bfd_elf_version_expr_head *head, | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *prev, | 
|  | const char *sym) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *c_sym; | 
|  | const char *cxx_sym = sym; | 
|  | const char *java_sym = sym; | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *expr = NULL; | 
|  | enum demangling_styles curr_style; | 
|  |  | 
|  | curr_style = CURRENT_DEMANGLING_STYLE; | 
|  | cplus_demangle_set_style (no_demangling); | 
|  | c_sym = bfd_demangle (link_info.output_bfd, sym, DMGL_NO_OPTS); | 
|  | if (!c_sym) | 
|  | c_sym = sym; | 
|  | cplus_demangle_set_style (curr_style); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (head->mask & BFD_ELF_VERSION_CXX_TYPE) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cxx_sym = bfd_demangle (link_info.output_bfd, sym, | 
|  | DMGL_PARAMS | DMGL_ANSI); | 
|  | if (!cxx_sym) | 
|  | cxx_sym = sym; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (head->mask & BFD_ELF_VERSION_JAVA_TYPE) | 
|  | { | 
|  | java_sym = bfd_demangle (link_info.output_bfd, sym, DMGL_JAVA); | 
|  | if (!java_sym) | 
|  | java_sym = sym; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (head->htab && (prev == NULL || prev->literal)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr e; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (prev ? prev->mask : 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | case 0: | 
|  | if (head->mask & BFD_ELF_VERSION_C_TYPE) | 
|  | { | 
|  | e.pattern = c_sym; | 
|  | expr = (struct bfd_elf_version_expr *) | 
|  | htab_find ((htab_t) head->htab, &e); | 
|  | while (expr && strcmp (expr->pattern, c_sym) == 0) | 
|  | if (expr->mask == BFD_ELF_VERSION_C_TYPE) | 
|  | goto out_ret; | 
|  | else | 
|  | expr = expr->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Fallthrough */ | 
|  | case BFD_ELF_VERSION_C_TYPE: | 
|  | if (head->mask & BFD_ELF_VERSION_CXX_TYPE) | 
|  | { | 
|  | e.pattern = cxx_sym; | 
|  | expr = (struct bfd_elf_version_expr *) | 
|  | htab_find ((htab_t) head->htab, &e); | 
|  | while (expr && strcmp (expr->pattern, cxx_sym) == 0) | 
|  | if (expr->mask == BFD_ELF_VERSION_CXX_TYPE) | 
|  | goto out_ret; | 
|  | else | 
|  | expr = expr->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Fallthrough */ | 
|  | case BFD_ELF_VERSION_CXX_TYPE: | 
|  | if (head->mask & BFD_ELF_VERSION_JAVA_TYPE) | 
|  | { | 
|  | e.pattern = java_sym; | 
|  | expr = (struct bfd_elf_version_expr *) | 
|  | htab_find ((htab_t) head->htab, &e); | 
|  | while (expr && strcmp (expr->pattern, java_sym) == 0) | 
|  | if (expr->mask == BFD_ELF_VERSION_JAVA_TYPE) | 
|  | goto out_ret; | 
|  | else | 
|  | expr = expr->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Fallthrough */ | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Finally, try the wildcards.  */ | 
|  | if (prev == NULL || prev->literal) | 
|  | expr = head->remaining; | 
|  | else | 
|  | expr = prev->next; | 
|  | for (; expr; expr = expr->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *s; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!expr->pattern) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (expr->pattern[0] == '*' && expr->pattern[1] == '\0') | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (expr->mask == BFD_ELF_VERSION_JAVA_TYPE) | 
|  | s = java_sym; | 
|  | else if (expr->mask == BFD_ELF_VERSION_CXX_TYPE) | 
|  | s = cxx_sym; | 
|  | else | 
|  | s = c_sym; | 
|  | if (fnmatch (expr->pattern, s, 0) == 0) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | out_ret: | 
|  | if (c_sym != sym) | 
|  | free ((char *) c_sym); | 
|  | if (cxx_sym != sym) | 
|  | free ((char *) cxx_sym); | 
|  | if (java_sym != sym) | 
|  | free ((char *) java_sym); | 
|  | return expr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return NULL if the PATTERN argument is a glob pattern, otherwise, | 
|  | return a pointer to the symbol name with any backslash quotes removed.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char * | 
|  | realsymbol (const char *pattern) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *p; | 
|  | bool changed = false, backslash = false; | 
|  | char *s, *symbol = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (pattern) + 1); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (p = pattern, s = symbol; *p != '\0'; ++p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* It is a glob pattern only if there is no preceding | 
|  | backslash.  */ | 
|  | if (backslash) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Remove the preceding backslash.  */ | 
|  | *(s - 1) = *p; | 
|  | backslash = false; | 
|  | changed = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (*p == '?' || *p == '*' || *p == '[') | 
|  | { | 
|  | free (symbol); | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | *s++ = *p; | 
|  | backslash = *p == '\\'; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (changed) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *s = '\0'; | 
|  | pattern = stat_strdup (symbol); | 
|  | } | 
|  | free (symbol); | 
|  | return pattern; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is called for each variable name or match expression.  NEW_NAME is | 
|  | the name of the symbol to match, or, if LITERAL_P is FALSE, a glob | 
|  | pattern to be matched against symbol names.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr * | 
|  | lang_new_vers_pattern (struct bfd_elf_version_expr *orig, | 
|  | const char *new_name, | 
|  | const char *lang, | 
|  | bool literal_p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *ret; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ret = stat_alloc (sizeof *ret); | 
|  | ret->next = orig; | 
|  | ret->symver = 0; | 
|  | ret->script = 0; | 
|  | ret->literal = true; | 
|  | ret->pattern = literal_p ? new_name : realsymbol (new_name); | 
|  | if (ret->pattern == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ret->pattern = new_name; | 
|  | ret->literal = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (lang == NULL || strcasecmp (lang, "C") == 0) | 
|  | ret->mask = BFD_ELF_VERSION_C_TYPE; | 
|  | else if (strcasecmp (lang, "C++") == 0) | 
|  | ret->mask = BFD_ELF_VERSION_CXX_TYPE; | 
|  | else if (strcasecmp (lang, "Java") == 0) | 
|  | ret->mask = BFD_ELF_VERSION_JAVA_TYPE; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: unknown language `%s' in version information\n"), | 
|  | lang); | 
|  | ret->mask = BFD_ELF_VERSION_C_TYPE; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return ldemul_new_vers_pattern (ret); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is called for each set of variable names and match | 
|  | expressions.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_tree * | 
|  | lang_new_vers_node (struct bfd_elf_version_expr *globals, | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *locals) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_tree *ret; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ret = stat_alloc (sizeof (*ret)); | 
|  | memset (ret, 0, sizeof (*ret)); | 
|  | ret->globals.list = globals; | 
|  | ret->locals.list = locals; | 
|  | ret->match = lang_vers_match; | 
|  | ret->name_indx = (unsigned int) -1; | 
|  | return ret; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This static variable keeps track of version indices.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int version_index; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static hashval_t | 
|  | version_expr_head_hash (const void *p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct bfd_elf_version_expr *e = | 
|  | (const struct bfd_elf_version_expr *) p; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return htab_hash_string (e->pattern); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static int | 
|  | version_expr_head_eq (const void *p1, const void *p2) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const struct bfd_elf_version_expr *e1 = | 
|  | (const struct bfd_elf_version_expr *) p1; | 
|  | const struct bfd_elf_version_expr *e2 = | 
|  | (const struct bfd_elf_version_expr *) p2; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return strcmp (e1->pattern, e2->pattern) == 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_finalize_version_expr_head (struct bfd_elf_version_expr_head *head) | 
|  | { | 
|  | size_t count = 0; | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *e, *next; | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr **list_loc, **remaining_loc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (e = head->list; e; e = e->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (e->literal) | 
|  | count++; | 
|  | head->mask |= e->mask; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (count) | 
|  | { | 
|  | head->htab = htab_create (count * 2, version_expr_head_hash, | 
|  | version_expr_head_eq, NULL); | 
|  | list_loc = &head->list; | 
|  | remaining_loc = &head->remaining; | 
|  | for (e = head->list; e; e = next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | next = e->next; | 
|  | if (!e->literal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | *remaining_loc = e; | 
|  | remaining_loc = &e->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | void **loc = htab_find_slot ((htab_t) head->htab, e, INSERT); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*loc) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *e1, *last; | 
|  |  | 
|  | e1 = (struct bfd_elf_version_expr *) *loc; | 
|  | last = NULL; | 
|  | do | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (e1->mask == e->mask) | 
|  | { | 
|  | last = NULL; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | last = e1; | 
|  | e1 = e1->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | while (e1 && strcmp (e1->pattern, e->pattern) == 0); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (last != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | e->next = last->next; | 
|  | last->next = e; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | *loc = e; | 
|  | *list_loc = e; | 
|  | list_loc = &e->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | *remaining_loc = NULL; | 
|  | *list_loc = head->remaining; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | head->remaining = head->list; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is called when we know the name and dependencies of the | 
|  | version.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_register_vers_node (const char *name, | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_tree *version, | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_deps *deps) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_tree *t, **pp; | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *e1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (name == NULL) | 
|  | name = ""; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (link_info.version_info != NULL | 
|  | && (name[0] == '\0' || link_info.version_info->name[0] == '\0')) | 
|  | { | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: anonymous version tag cannot be combined" | 
|  | " with other version tags\n")); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure this node has a unique name.  */ | 
|  | for (t = link_info.version_info; t != NULL; t = t->next) | 
|  | if (strcmp (t->name, name) == 0) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: duplicate version tag `%s'\n"), name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_finalize_version_expr_head (&version->globals); | 
|  | lang_finalize_version_expr_head (&version->locals); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check the global and local match names, and make sure there | 
|  | aren't any duplicates.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (e1 = version->globals.list; e1 != NULL; e1 = e1->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (t = link_info.version_info; t != NULL; t = t->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *e2; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (t->locals.htab && e1->literal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | e2 = (struct bfd_elf_version_expr *) | 
|  | htab_find ((htab_t) t->locals.htab, e1); | 
|  | while (e2 && strcmp (e1->pattern, e2->pattern) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (e1->mask == e2->mask) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: duplicate expression `%s'" | 
|  | " in version information\n"), e1->pattern); | 
|  | e2 = e2->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (!e1->literal) | 
|  | for (e2 = t->locals.remaining; e2 != NULL; e2 = e2->next) | 
|  | if (strcmp (e1->pattern, e2->pattern) == 0 | 
|  | && e1->mask == e2->mask) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: duplicate expression `%s'" | 
|  | " in version information\n"), e1->pattern); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (e1 = version->locals.list; e1 != NULL; e1 = e1->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (t = link_info.version_info; t != NULL; t = t->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *e2; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (t->globals.htab && e1->literal) | 
|  | { | 
|  | e2 = (struct bfd_elf_version_expr *) | 
|  | htab_find ((htab_t) t->globals.htab, e1); | 
|  | while (e2 && strcmp (e1->pattern, e2->pattern) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (e1->mask == e2->mask) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: duplicate expression `%s'" | 
|  | " in version information\n"), | 
|  | e1->pattern); | 
|  | e2 = e2->next; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (!e1->literal) | 
|  | for (e2 = t->globals.remaining; e2 != NULL; e2 = e2->next) | 
|  | if (strcmp (e1->pattern, e2->pattern) == 0 | 
|  | && e1->mask == e2->mask) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: duplicate expression `%s'" | 
|  | " in version information\n"), e1->pattern); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | version->deps = deps; | 
|  | version->name = name; | 
|  | if (name[0] != '\0') | 
|  | { | 
|  | ++version_index; | 
|  | version->vernum = version_index; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | version->vernum = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (pp = &link_info.version_info; *pp != NULL; pp = &(*pp)->next) | 
|  | ; | 
|  | *pp = version; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This is called when we see a version dependency.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_deps * | 
|  | lang_add_vers_depend (struct bfd_elf_version_deps *list, const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_deps *ret; | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_tree *t; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ret = stat_alloc (sizeof *ret); | 
|  | ret->next = list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (t = link_info.version_info; t != NULL; t = t->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (strcmp (t->name, name) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ret->version_needed = t; | 
|  | return ret; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: unable to find version dependency `%s'\n"), name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ret->version_needed = NULL; | 
|  | return ret; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_do_version_exports_section (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *greg = NULL, *lreg; | 
|  |  | 
|  | LANG_FOR_EACH_INPUT_STATEMENT (is) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asection *sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (is->the_bfd, ".exports"); | 
|  | char *contents, *p; | 
|  | bfd_size_type len; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (sec == NULL) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | len = sec->size; | 
|  | contents = stat_alloc (len); | 
|  | if (!bfd_get_section_contents (is->the_bfd, sec, contents, 0, len)) | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: unable to read .exports section contents\n"), sec); | 
|  |  | 
|  | p = contents; | 
|  | while (p < contents + len) | 
|  | { | 
|  | greg = lang_new_vers_pattern (greg, p, NULL, false); | 
|  | p = strchr (p, '\0') + 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do not include this section in the link.  */ | 
|  | sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE | SEC_KEEP; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | lreg = lang_new_vers_pattern (NULL, "*", NULL, false); | 
|  | lang_register_vers_node (command_line.version_exports_section, | 
|  | lang_new_vers_node (greg, lreg), NULL); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Evaluate LENGTH and ORIGIN parts of MEMORY spec.  This is initially | 
|  | called with UPDATE_REGIONS_P set to FALSE, in this case no errors are | 
|  | thrown, however, references to symbols in the origin and length fields | 
|  | will be pushed into the symbol table, this allows PROVIDE statements to | 
|  | then provide these symbols.  This function is called a second time with | 
|  | UPDATE_REGIONS_P set to TRUE, this time the we update the actual region | 
|  | data structures, and throw errors if missing symbols are encountered.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_do_memory_regions (bool update_regions_p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *r = lang_memory_region_list; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; r != NULL; r = r->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (r->origin_exp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | exp_fold_tree_no_dot (r->origin_exp, NULL); | 
|  | if (update_regions_p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (expld.result.valid_p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | r->origin = expld.result.value; | 
|  | r->current = r->origin; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: invalid origin for memory region %s\n"), | 
|  | r->name_list.name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (r->length_exp) | 
|  | { | 
|  | exp_fold_tree_no_dot (r->length_exp, NULL); | 
|  | if (update_regions_p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (expld.result.valid_p) | 
|  | r->length = expld.result.value; | 
|  | else | 
|  | einfo (_("%P: invalid length for memory region %s\n"), | 
|  | r->name_list.name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_add_unique (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct unique_sections *ent; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ent = unique_section_list; ent; ent = ent->next) | 
|  | if (strcmp (ent->name, name) == 0) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ent = stat_alloc (sizeof *ent); | 
|  | ent->name = stat_strdup (name); | 
|  | ent->next = unique_section_list; | 
|  | unique_section_list = ent; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Append the list of dynamic symbols to the existing one.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_append_dynamic_list (struct bfd_elf_dynamic_list **list_p, | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *dynamic) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (*list_p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *tail; | 
|  | for (tail = dynamic; tail->next != NULL; tail = tail->next) | 
|  | ; | 
|  | tail->next = (*list_p)->head.list; | 
|  | (*list_p)->head.list = dynamic; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_dynamic_list *d; | 
|  |  | 
|  | d = stat_alloc (sizeof (*d)); | 
|  | memset (d, 0, sizeof (*d)); | 
|  | d->head.list = dynamic; | 
|  | d->match = lang_vers_match; | 
|  | *list_p = d; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Append the list of C++ typeinfo dynamic symbols to the existing | 
|  | one.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_append_dynamic_list_cpp_typeinfo (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *symbols[] = | 
|  | { | 
|  | "typeinfo name for*", | 
|  | "typeinfo for*" | 
|  | }; | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *dynamic = NULL; | 
|  | unsigned int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (symbols); i++) | 
|  | dynamic = lang_new_vers_pattern (dynamic, symbols [i], "C++", | 
|  | false); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_append_dynamic_list (&link_info.dynamic_list, dynamic); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Append the list of C++ operator new and delete dynamic symbols to the | 
|  | existing one.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_append_dynamic_list_cpp_new (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *symbols[] = | 
|  | { | 
|  | "operator new*", | 
|  | "operator delete*" | 
|  | }; | 
|  | struct bfd_elf_version_expr *dynamic = NULL; | 
|  | unsigned int i; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (symbols); i++) | 
|  | dynamic = lang_new_vers_pattern (dynamic, symbols [i], "C++", | 
|  | false); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_append_dynamic_list (&link_info.dynamic_list, dynamic); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Scan a space and/or comma separated string of features.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_ld_feature (char *str) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char *p, *q; | 
|  |  | 
|  | p = str; | 
|  | while (*p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | char sep; | 
|  | while (*p == ',' || ISSPACE (*p)) | 
|  | ++p; | 
|  | if (!*p) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | q = p + 1; | 
|  | while (*q && *q != ',' && !ISSPACE (*q)) | 
|  | ++q; | 
|  | sep = *q; | 
|  | *q = 0; | 
|  | if (strcasecmp (p, "SANE_EXPR") == 0) | 
|  | config.sane_expr = true; | 
|  | else | 
|  | einfo (_("%X%P: unknown feature `%s'\n"), p); | 
|  | *q = sep; | 
|  | p = q; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Pretty print memory amount.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | lang_print_memory_size (uint64_t sz) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (sz == 0) | 
|  | printf (" %10" PRIu64 " B", sz); | 
|  | else if ((sz & 0x3fffffff) == 0) | 
|  | printf ("%10" PRIu64 " GB", sz >> 30); | 
|  | else if ((sz & 0xfffff) == 0) | 
|  | printf ("%10" PRIu64 " MB", sz >> 20); | 
|  | else if ((sz & 0x3ff) == 0) | 
|  | printf ("%10" PRIu64 " KB", sz >> 10); | 
|  | else | 
|  | printf (" %10" PRIu64 " B", sz); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Implement --print-memory-usage: disply per region memory usage.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | lang_print_memory_usage (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_memory_region_type *r; | 
|  |  | 
|  | printf ("Memory region         Used Size  Region Size  %%age Used\n"); | 
|  | for (r = lang_memory_region_list; r->next != NULL; r = r->next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma used_length = r->current - r->origin; | 
|  |  | 
|  | printf ("%16s: ",r->name_list.name); | 
|  | lang_print_memory_size (used_length); | 
|  | lang_print_memory_size (r->length); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (r->length != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | double percent = used_length * 100.0 / r->length; | 
|  | printf ("    %6.2f%%", percent); | 
|  | } | 
|  | printf ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | cmdline_lists_init (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cmdline_object_only_file_list.tail | 
|  | = &cmdline_object_only_file_list.head; | 
|  | cmdline_object_only_archive_list.tail | 
|  | = &cmdline_object_only_archive_list.head; | 
|  | cmdline_temp_object_only_list.tail | 
|  | = &cmdline_temp_object_only_list.head; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allocate an item with TYPE and DATA.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static cmdline_union_type * | 
|  | cmdline_list_new (cmdline_enum_type type, void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cmdline_union_type *new_opt; | 
|  |  | 
|  | new_opt = (cmdline_union_type *) stat_alloc (sizeof (*new_opt)); | 
|  | new_opt->header.type = type; | 
|  | switch (type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case cmdline_is_file_enum: | 
|  | new_opt->file.filename = (const char *) data; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case cmdline_is_bfd_enum: | 
|  | new_opt->abfd.abfd = (bfd *) data; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return new_opt; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Append an item with TYPE and DATA to LIST.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | cmdline_list_append (cmdline_list_type *list, cmdline_enum_type type, | 
|  | void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cmdline_union_type *new_opt = cmdline_list_new (type, data); | 
|  | new_opt->header.next = NULL; | 
|  | *list->tail = new_opt; | 
|  | list->tail = &new_opt->header.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | print_cmdline_list (cmdline_union_type *c) | 
|  | { | 
|  | for (; c != NULL; c = c->header.next) | 
|  | switch (c->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | case cmdline_is_file_enum: | 
|  | info_msg (" %s", c->file.filename); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case cmdline_is_bfd_enum: | 
|  | info_msg (" [%B]", c->abfd.abfd); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | info_msg ("\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Return TRUE if ABFD is on cmdline_object_only_archive_list.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool | 
|  | cmdline_on_object_only_archive_list_p (bfd *abfd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cmdline_union_type *c, *next; | 
|  | bfd *archive, *obfd, *oarchive; | 
|  | ufile_ptr origin = abfd->origin; | 
|  |  | 
|  | archive = abfd->my_archive; | 
|  | for (c = cmdline_object_only_archive_list.head; c != NULL; c = next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (c->header.type != cmdline_is_bfd_enum) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | next = c->header.next; | 
|  | obfd = c->abfd.abfd; | 
|  | oarchive = obfd->my_archive; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* The list is grouped by archive file name and sorted by member | 
|  | origin.  */ | 
|  | if (strcmp (archive->filename, oarchive->filename) != 0) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (origin == obfd->origin) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | else if (origin < obfd->origin) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Append an item with TYPE and DATA to cmdline_object_only_file_list | 
|  | or cmdline_object_only_archive_list if needed.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | cmdline_object_only_list_append (cmdline_enum_type type, void *data) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cmdline_union_type *c; | 
|  | cmdline_union_type *new_opt, *next, **prev; | 
|  | bfd *abfd, *archive; | 
|  | bfd *obfd, *oarchive; | 
|  | bfd *nbfd, *narchive; | 
|  | ufile_ptr origin, norigin; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Put it on cmdline_object_only_file_list if it isn't an archive | 
|  | member.  */ | 
|  | switch (type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | case cmdline_is_bfd_enum: | 
|  | abfd = (bfd *) data; | 
|  | archive = abfd->my_archive; | 
|  | if (archive) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | /* Fallthru */ | 
|  | case cmdline_is_file_enum: | 
|  | cmdline_list_append (&cmdline_object_only_file_list, type, data); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Put archive member on cmdline_object_only_archive_list and sort | 
|  | the list by archive name and archive member origin.  */ | 
|  | new_opt = (cmdline_union_type *) stat_alloc (sizeof (*new_opt)); | 
|  | new_opt->header.type = cmdline_is_bfd_enum; | 
|  | new_opt->header.next = NULL; | 
|  | new_opt->abfd.abfd = (bfd *) data; | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = cmdline_object_only_archive_list.head; | 
|  | if (c == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cmdline_object_only_archive_list.head = new_opt; | 
|  | cmdline_object_only_archive_list.tail = &new_opt->header.next; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | prev = NULL; | 
|  | origin = abfd->origin; | 
|  | for (; c != NULL; c = next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (c->header.type != cmdline_is_bfd_enum) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | next = c->header.next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | obfd = c->abfd.abfd; | 
|  | oarchive = obfd->my_archive; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (strcmp (archive->filename, oarchive->filename) == 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bool after; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (origin < obfd->origin) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Insert it before the current.  */ | 
|  | new_opt->header.next = c; | 
|  | if (prev) | 
|  | *prev = new_opt; | 
|  | else | 
|  | cmdline_object_only_archive_list.head = new_opt; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | after = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check origin.  */ | 
|  | while (next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (next->header.type != cmdline_is_bfd_enum) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | nbfd = next->abfd.abfd; | 
|  | norigin = nbfd->origin; | 
|  | if (origin > norigin) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Insert it after NEXT.  */ | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | narchive = nbfd->my_archive; | 
|  | if (strcmp (archive->filename, narchive->filename) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Insert it befor NEXT.  */ | 
|  | after = false; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = next; | 
|  | next = next->header.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (after && next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | c = next; | 
|  | next = next->header.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (*cmdline_object_only_archive_list.tail == c->header.next) | 
|  | cmdline_object_only_archive_list.tail | 
|  | = &new_opt->header.next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | prev = &c->header.next; | 
|  | new_opt->header.next = next; | 
|  | *prev = new_opt; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | prev = &c->header.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | *cmdline_object_only_archive_list.tail = new_opt; | 
|  | cmdline_object_only_archive_list.tail = &new_opt->header.next; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Get object-only input files.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | cmdline_get_object_only_input_files (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cmdline_union_type *c, *next; | 
|  | bfd *abfd, *archive; | 
|  | bfd *nbfd, *narchive; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add files first.  */ | 
|  | for (c = cmdline_object_only_file_list.head; | 
|  | c != NULL; c = c->header.next) | 
|  | switch (c->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | case cmdline_is_file_enum: | 
|  | lang_add_input_file (c->file.filename, | 
|  | lang_input_file_is_file_enum, NULL); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case cmdline_is_bfd_enum: | 
|  | abfd = c->abfd.abfd; | 
|  | if (abfd->my_archive) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | lang_add_input_file (abfd->filename, | 
|  | lang_input_file_is_file_enum, NULL); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add archive members next.  */ | 
|  | for (c = cmdline_object_only_archive_list.head; c != NULL; c = next) | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (c->header.type != cmdline_is_bfd_enum) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | next = c->header.next; | 
|  |  | 
|  | abfd = c->abfd.abfd; | 
|  | archive = abfd->my_archive; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add the first archive of the archive member group.  */ | 
|  | lang_add_input_file (archive->filename, | 
|  | lang_input_file_is_file_enum, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Skip the rest members in the archive member group.  */ | 
|  | do | 
|  | { | 
|  | if (!next) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (next->header.type != cmdline_is_bfd_enum) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | next = next->header.next; | 
|  | if (!next) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | nbfd = next->abfd.abfd; | 
|  | narchive = nbfd->my_archive; | 
|  | } | 
|  | while (strcmp (archive->filename, narchive->filename) == 0); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct cmdline_arg | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd *obfd; | 
|  | asymbol **isympp; | 
|  | int status; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create a section in OBFD with the same | 
|  | name and attributes as ISECTION in IBFD.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | setup_section (bfd *ibfd, sec_ptr isection, void *p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cmdline_arg *arg = (struct cmdline_arg *) p; | 
|  | bfd *obfd = arg->obfd; | 
|  | asymbol **isympp = arg->isympp; | 
|  | const char *name = isection->name; | 
|  | sec_ptr osection; | 
|  | const char *err; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Skip the object-only section.  */ | 
|  | if (ibfd->object_only_section == isection) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have already failed earlier on, do not keep on generating | 
|  | complaints now.  */ | 
|  | if (arg->status) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | osection = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (obfd, name, | 
|  | isection->flags); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (osection == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = _("failed to create output section"); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | osection->size = isection->size; | 
|  | osection->vma = isection->vma; | 
|  | osection->lma = isection->lma; | 
|  | osection->alignment_power = isection->alignment_power; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Copy merge entity size.  */ | 
|  | osection->entsize = isection->entsize; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This used to be mangle_section; we do here to avoid using | 
|  | bfd_get_section_by_name since some formats allow multiple | 
|  | sections with the same name.  */ | 
|  | isection->output_section = osection; | 
|  | isection->output_offset = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((isection->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asymbol *gsym = bfd_group_signature (isection, isympp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (gsym != NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | gsym->flags |= BSF_KEEP; | 
|  | if (ibfd->xvec->flavour == bfd_target_elf_flavour) | 
|  | elf_group_id (isection) = gsym; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allow the BFD backend to copy any private data it understands | 
|  | from the input section to the output section.  */ | 
|  | if (!bfd_copy_private_section_data (ibfd, isection, obfd, osection)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = _("failed to copy private data"); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* All went well.  */ | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loser: | 
|  | arg->status = 1; | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: setup_section: %s: %s\n"), err, name); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Copy the data of input section ISECTION of IBFD | 
|  | to an output section with the same name in OBFD. | 
|  | If stripping then don't copy any relocation info.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | copy_section (bfd *ibfd, sec_ptr isection, void *p) | 
|  | { | 
|  | struct cmdline_arg *arg = (struct cmdline_arg *) p; | 
|  | bfd *obfd = arg->obfd; | 
|  | asymbol **isympp = arg->isympp; | 
|  | arelent **relpp; | 
|  | long relcount; | 
|  | sec_ptr osection; | 
|  | bfd_size_type size; | 
|  | long relsize; | 
|  | flagword flags; | 
|  | const char *err; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Skip the object-only section.  */ | 
|  | if (ibfd->object_only_section == isection) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* If we have already failed earlier on, do not keep on generating | 
|  | complaints now.  */ | 
|  | if (arg->status) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | flags = bfd_section_flags (isection); | 
|  | if ((flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | osection = isection->output_section; | 
|  | size = bfd_section_size (isection); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (size == 0 || osection == 0) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | relsize = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (ibfd, isection); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (relsize < 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Do not complain if the target does not support relocations.  */ | 
|  | if (relsize == -1 | 
|  | && bfd_get_error () == bfd_error_invalid_operation) | 
|  | relsize = 0; | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = bfd_errmsg (bfd_get_error ()); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (relsize == 0) | 
|  | bfd_set_reloc (obfd, osection, NULL, 0); | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | relpp = (arelent **) xmalloc (relsize); | 
|  | relcount = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (ibfd, isection, relpp, isympp); | 
|  | if (relcount < 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = _("relocation count is negative"); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bfd_set_reloc (obfd, osection, | 
|  | relcount == 0 ? NULL : relpp, relcount); | 
|  | if (relcount == 0) | 
|  | free (relpp); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bfd_section_flags (isection) & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_byte *memhunk = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_get_full_section_contents (ibfd, isection, &memhunk)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = bfd_errmsg (bfd_get_error ()); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_set_section_contents (obfd, osection, memhunk, 0, size)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = bfd_errmsg (bfd_get_error ()); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  | free (memhunk); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* All went well.  */ | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loser: | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: copy_section: %s: %s\n"), err, isection->name); | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* Open the temporary bfd created in the same directory as PATH.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bfd * | 
|  | cmdline_fopen_temp (const char *path, const char *target, | 
|  | const char *mode) | 
|  | { | 
|  | #define template "ldXXXXXX" | 
|  | const char *slash = strrchr (path, '/'); | 
|  | char *tmpname; | 
|  | size_t len; | 
|  | int fd; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef HAVE_DOS_BASED_FILE_SYSTEM | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* We could have foo/bar\\baz, or foo\\bar, or d:bar.  */ | 
|  | char *bslash = strrchr (path, '\\'); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (slash == NULL || (bslash != NULL && bslash > slash)) | 
|  | slash = bslash; | 
|  | if (slash == NULL && path[0] != '\0' && path[1] == ':') | 
|  | slash = path + 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (slash != (char *) NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | len = slash - path; | 
|  | tmpname = (char *) xmalloc (len + sizeof (template) + 2); | 
|  | memcpy (tmpname, path, len); | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef HAVE_DOS_BASED_FILE_SYSTEM | 
|  | /* If tmpname is "X:", appending a slash will make it a root | 
|  | directory on drive X, which is NOT the same as the current | 
|  | directory on drive X.  */ | 
|  | if (len == 2 && tmpname[1] == ':') | 
|  | tmpname[len++] = '.'; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | tmpname[len++] = '/'; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | { | 
|  | tmpname = (char *) xmalloc (sizeof (template)); | 
|  | len = 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | memcpy (tmpname + len, template, sizeof (template)); | 
|  | #undef template | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef HAVE_MKSTEMP | 
|  | fd = mkstemp (tmpname); | 
|  | #else | 
|  | tmpname = mktemp (tmpname); | 
|  | if (tmpname == NULL) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | fd = open (tmpname, O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL, 0600); | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | if (fd == -1) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | return bfd_fopen (tmpname, target, mode, fd); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Add the object-only section.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | cmdline_add_object_only_section (bfd_byte *contents, size_t size) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_vma start; | 
|  | flagword flags; | 
|  | enum bfd_architecture iarch; | 
|  | unsigned int imach; | 
|  | long symcount; | 
|  | long symsize; | 
|  | asymbol **isympp = NULL; | 
|  | asymbol **osympp = NULL; | 
|  | bfd *obfd = NULL, *ibfd; | 
|  | const char *err; | 
|  | struct arg | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd *obfd; | 
|  | asymbol **isympp; | 
|  | int status; | 
|  | } arg; | 
|  | char **matching; | 
|  | char *ofilename = NULL; | 
|  | asection *sec; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ibfd = bfd_openr (output_filename, output_target); | 
|  | if (!ibfd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = bfd_errmsg (bfd_get_error ()); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_check_format_matches (ibfd, bfd_object, &matching)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = bfd_errmsg (bfd_get_error ()); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | obfd = cmdline_fopen_temp (output_filename, output_target, FOPEN_WB); | 
|  | if (!obfd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = bfd_errmsg (bfd_get_error ()); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  | /* To be used after bfd_close ().  */ | 
|  | ofilename = xstrdup (bfd_get_filename (obfd)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_set_format (obfd, bfd_object)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = bfd_errmsg (bfd_get_error ()); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Copy the start address, flags and architecture of input file to | 
|  | output file.  */ | 
|  | flags = bfd_get_file_flags (ibfd); | 
|  | start = bfd_get_start_address (ibfd); | 
|  | iarch = bfd_get_arch (ibfd); | 
|  | imach = bfd_get_mach (ibfd); | 
|  | if (!bfd_set_start_address (obfd, start) | 
|  | || !bfd_set_file_flags (obfd, flags) | 
|  | || !bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, iarch, imach)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = bfd_errmsg (bfd_get_error ()); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | symsize = bfd_get_symtab_upper_bound (ibfd); | 
|  | if (symsize < 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = bfd_errmsg (bfd_get_error ()); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | isympp = (asymbol **) xmalloc (symsize); | 
|  | symcount = bfd_canonicalize_symtab (ibfd, isympp); | 
|  | if (symcount < 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = bfd_errmsg (bfd_get_error ()); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | arg.obfd = obfd; | 
|  | arg.isympp = isympp; | 
|  | arg.status = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* BFD mandates that all output sections be created and sizes set before | 
|  | any output is done.  Thus, we traverse all sections multiple times.  */ | 
|  | bfd_map_over_sections (ibfd, setup_section, &arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg.status) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = _("error setting up sections"); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allow the BFD backend to copy any private data it understands | 
|  | from the input section to the output section.  */ | 
|  | if (! bfd_copy_private_header_data (ibfd, obfd)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = _("error copying private header data"); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Create the object-only section.  */ | 
|  | sec = bfd_make_section_with_flags (obfd, | 
|  | GNU_OBJECT_ONLY_SECTION_NAME, | 
|  | (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | 
|  | | SEC_READONLY | 
|  | | SEC_DATA | 
|  | | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)); | 
|  | if (sec == NULL) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = _("can't create object-only section"); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (! bfd_set_section_size (sec, size)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = _("can't set object-only section size"); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ibfd->object_only_section) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* Filter out the object-only section symbol.  */ | 
|  | long src_count = 0, dst_count = 0; | 
|  | asymbol **from, **to; | 
|  |  | 
|  | osympp = xmalloc ((symcount + 1) * sizeof (asymbol *)); | 
|  | from = isympp; | 
|  | to = osympp; | 
|  | for (; src_count < symcount; src_count++) | 
|  | { | 
|  | asymbol *sym = from[src_count]; | 
|  | if (bfd_asymbol_section (sym) != ibfd->object_only_section) | 
|  | to[dst_count++] = sym; | 
|  | } | 
|  | to[dst_count] = NULL; | 
|  | symcount = dst_count; | 
|  | bfd_set_symtab (obfd, osympp, symcount); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else | 
|  | bfd_set_symtab (obfd, isympp, symcount); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* This has to happen after the symbol table has been set.  */ | 
|  | bfd_map_over_sections (ibfd, copy_section, &arg); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (arg.status) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = _("error copying sections"); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Copy the object-only section to the output.  */ | 
|  | if (! bfd_set_section_contents (obfd, sec, contents, 0, size)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = _("error adding object-only section"); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Allow the BFD backend to copy any private data it understands | 
|  | from the input BFD to the output BFD.  This is done last to | 
|  | permit the routine to look at the filtered symbol table, which is | 
|  | important for the ECOFF code at least.  */ | 
|  | if (! bfd_copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | err = _("error copying private BFD data"); | 
|  | goto loser; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_close (obfd)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | unlink (ofilename); | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: failed to finish output with object-only section\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Must be freed after bfd_close ().  */ | 
|  | free (isympp); | 
|  | free (osympp); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (rename (ofilename, output_filename)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | unlink (ofilename); | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: failed to rename output with object-only section\n")); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | free (ofilename); | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | loser: | 
|  | free (isympp); | 
|  | free (osympp); | 
|  | if (obfd) | 
|  | bfd_close (obfd); | 
|  | if (ofilename) | 
|  | { | 
|  | unlink (ofilename); | 
|  | free (ofilename); | 
|  | } | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: failed to add object-only section: %s\n"), err); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Emit the final output with object-only section.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | cmdline_emit_object_only_section (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *saved_output_filename = output_filename; | 
|  | int fd; | 
|  | size_t size, off; | 
|  | bfd_byte *contents; | 
|  | struct stat st; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Get a temporary object-only file.  */ | 
|  | output_filename = make_temp_file (".obj-only.o"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | had_output_filename = false; | 
|  | link_info.input_bfds = NULL; | 
|  | link_info.input_bfds_tail = &link_info.input_bfds; | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_init (true); | 
|  | ldexp_init (true); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set up the object-only output. */ | 
|  | lang_final (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Open the object-only file for output.  */ | 
|  | lang_for_each_statement (ldlang_open_output); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_create_output_section_statements (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!bfd_section_already_linked_table_init ()) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: Failed to create hash table\n")); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Call cmdline_on_object_only_archive_list_p to check which member | 
|  | should be loaded.  */ | 
|  | input_flags.whole_archive = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Set it to avoid adding more to cmdline lists.  */ | 
|  | config.emitting_gnu_object_only = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Get object-only input files.  */ | 
|  | cmdline_get_object_only_input_files (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Open object-only input files.  */ | 
|  | open_input_bfds (statement_list.head, NULL, OPEN_BFD_NORMAL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_after_open (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bfd_section_already_linked_table_free (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure that we're not mixing architectures.  We call this | 
|  | after all the input files have been opened, but before we do any | 
|  | other processing, so that any operations merge_private_bfd_data | 
|  | does on the output file will be known during the rest of the | 
|  | link.  */ | 
|  | lang_check (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Size up the common data.  */ | 
|  | lang_common (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Update wild statements.  */ | 
|  | update_wild_statements (statement_list.head); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Run through the contours of the script and attach input sections | 
|  | to the correct output sections.  */ | 
|  | map_input_to_output_sections (statement_list.head, NULL, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Find any sections not attached explicitly and handle them.  */ | 
|  | lang_place_orphans (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Do anything special before sizing sections.  This is where ELF | 
|  | and other back-ends size dynamic sections.  */ | 
|  | ldemul_before_allocation (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Size up the sections.  */ | 
|  | lang_size_sections (NULL, ! RELAXATION_ENABLED); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* See if anything special should be done now we know how big | 
|  | everything is.  This is where relaxation is done.  */ | 
|  | ldemul_after_allocation (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldemul_finish (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Make sure that the section addresses make sense.  */ | 
|  | if (command_line.check_section_addresses) | 
|  | lang_check_section_addresses (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | lang_end (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldwrite (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldexp_finish (true); | 
|  | lang_finish (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (! bfd_close (link_info.output_bfd)) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P:%s: final close failed on object-only output: %E\n"), | 
|  | output_filename); | 
|  |  | 
|  | link_info.output_bfd = NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Read in the object-only file.  */ | 
|  | fd = open (output_filename, O_RDONLY | O_BINARY); | 
|  | if (fd < 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_set_error (bfd_error_system_call); | 
|  | fatal (_("%P:%s: cannot open object-only output: %E\n"), | 
|  | output_filename); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Get the object-only file size.  */ | 
|  | if (fstat (fd, &st) != 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_set_error (bfd_error_system_call); | 
|  | fatal (_("%P:%s: cannot stat object-only output: %E\n"), | 
|  | output_filename); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | size = st.st_size; | 
|  | off = 0; | 
|  | contents = (bfd_byte *) xmalloc (size); | 
|  | while (off != size) | 
|  | { | 
|  | ssize_t got; | 
|  |  | 
|  | got = read (fd, contents + off, size - off); | 
|  | if (got < 0) | 
|  | { | 
|  | bfd_set_error (bfd_error_system_call); | 
|  | fatal (_("%P:%s: read failed on object-only output: %E\n"), | 
|  | output_filename); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | off += got; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | close (fd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove the temporary object-only file.  */ | 
|  | unlink (output_filename); | 
|  |  | 
|  | output_filename = saved_output_filename; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cmdline_add_object_only_section (contents, size); | 
|  |  | 
|  | free (contents); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Extract the object-only section.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const char * | 
|  | cmdline_extract_object_only_section (bfd *abfd) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *name = bfd_extract_object_only_section (abfd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (name == NULL) | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: cannot extract object-only section from %B: %E\n"), abfd); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* It should be removed after it is done.  */ | 
|  | cmdline_list_append (&cmdline_temp_object_only_list, | 
|  | cmdline_is_file_enum, (void *) name); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return name; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Load the object-only section.   */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void | 
|  | cmdline_load_object_only_section (const char *name) | 
|  | { | 
|  | lang_input_statement_type *entry | 
|  | = new_afile (name, lang_input_file_is_file_enum, NULL, NULL); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!entry) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldfile_open_file (entry); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (trace_files || verbose) | 
|  | info_msg ("%pI\n", entry); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (entry->flags.missing_file | 
|  | || bfd_get_format (entry->the_bfd) != bfd_object) | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ldlang_add_file (entry); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (bfd_link_add_symbols (entry->the_bfd, &link_info)) | 
|  | entry->flags.loaded = true; | 
|  | else | 
|  | fatal (_("%P: %pB: error adding symbols: %E\n"), entry->the_bfd); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Check and handle the object-only section.   */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | cmdline_check_object_only_section (bfd *abfd, bool lto) | 
|  | { | 
|  | const char *filename; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.emitting_gnu_object_only || abfd->format != bfd_object) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (lto) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* For LTO link, we only need to extract object-only section | 
|  | from the mixed object, add it to input, and put it on LTO | 
|  | claimed output.  */ | 
|  | switch (bfd_get_lto_type (abfd)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | case lto_mixed_object: | 
|  | filename = cmdline_extract_object_only_section (abfd); | 
|  | cmdline_load_object_only_section (filename); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lto_non_ir_object: | 
|  | case lto_slim_ir_object: | 
|  | case lto_fat_ir_object: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | else if (bfd_link_relocatable (&link_info)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | /* For non-LTO relocatable link, we need to append non-IR object | 
|  | file and the object file in object-only section to the object | 
|  | only list.  */ | 
|  | switch (bfd_get_lto_type (abfd)) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | case lto_mixed_object: | 
|  | filename = cmdline_extract_object_only_section (abfd); | 
|  | cmdline_object_only_list_append (cmdline_is_file_enum, | 
|  | (void *) filename); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lto_non_ir_object: | 
|  | cmdline_object_only_list_append (cmdline_is_bfd_enum, abfd); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case lto_slim_ir_object: | 
|  | case lto_fat_ir_object: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* Remove temporary object-only files.  */ | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | cmdline_remove_object_only_files (void) | 
|  | { | 
|  | cmdline_union_type *c; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (config.plugin_save_temps) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | c = cmdline_temp_object_only_list.head; | 
|  | for (; c != NULL; c = c->header.next) | 
|  | switch (c->header.type) | 
|  | { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | abort (); | 
|  | case cmdline_is_file_enum: | 
|  | unlink (c->file.filename); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } |